blob: be4f775731773d9afd7603795db96acb9a8f4d47 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000039#include "llvm/LLVMContext.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000040#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000041#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000042#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +000043#include "llvm/Operator.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000044#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +000045#include "llvm/Analysis/MallocHelper.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000046#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000047#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
48#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
49#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000051#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Torok Edwin7d696d82009-07-11 13:10:19 +000053#include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000054#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000055#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000056#include "llvm/Support/IRBuilder.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000057#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000058#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000059#include "llvm/Support/TargetFolder.h"
Daniel Dunbarce63ffb2009-07-25 00:23:56 +000060#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000061#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000062#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000063#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000064#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000065#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000066#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000067#include <climits>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000068using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000069using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000070
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000071STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
72STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
73STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
74STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
75STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000076
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000077namespace {
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000078 /// InstCombineWorklist - This is the worklist management logic for
79 /// InstCombine.
80 class InstCombineWorklist {
81 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
82 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
83
84 void operator=(const InstCombineWorklist&RHS); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
85 InstCombineWorklist(const InstCombineWorklist&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
86 public:
87 InstCombineWorklist() {}
88
89 bool isEmpty() const { return Worklist.empty(); }
90
91 /// Add - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it isn't already
92 /// in it.
93 void Add(Instruction *I) {
Jeffrey Yasskin43069632009-10-08 00:12:24 +000094 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second) {
95 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ADD: " << *I << '\n');
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000096 Worklist.push_back(I);
Jeffrey Yasskin43069632009-10-08 00:12:24 +000097 }
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000098 }
99
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +0000100 void AddValue(Value *V) {
101 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
102 Add(I);
103 }
104
Chris Lattner67f7d542009-10-12 03:58:40 +0000105 /// AddInitialGroup - Add the specified batch of stuff in reverse order.
106 /// which should only be done when the worklist is empty and when the group
107 /// has no duplicates.
108 void AddInitialGroup(Instruction *const *List, unsigned NumEntries) {
109 assert(Worklist.empty() && "Worklist must be empty to add initial group");
110 Worklist.reserve(NumEntries+16);
111 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ADDING: " << NumEntries << " instrs to worklist\n");
112 for (; NumEntries; --NumEntries) {
113 Instruction *I = List[NumEntries-1];
114 WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size()));
115 Worklist.push_back(I);
116 }
117 }
118
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000119 // Remove - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000120 void Remove(Instruction *I) {
121 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
122 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
123
124 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
125 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
126
127 WorklistMap.erase(It);
128 }
129
130 Instruction *RemoveOne() {
131 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
132 Worklist.pop_back();
133 WorklistMap.erase(I);
134 return I;
135 }
136
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +0000137 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
138 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
139 /// now.
140 ///
141 void AddUsersToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
142 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
143 UI != UE; ++UI)
144 Add(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
145 }
146
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000147
148 /// Zap - check that the worklist is empty and nuke the backing store for
149 /// the map if it is large.
150 void Zap() {
151 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
152
153 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
154 WorklistMap.clear();
155 }
156 };
157} // end anonymous namespace.
158
159
160namespace {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000161 /// InstCombineIRInserter - This is an IRBuilder insertion helper that works
162 /// just like the normal insertion helper, but also adds any new instructions
163 /// to the instcombine worklist.
164 class InstCombineIRInserter : public IRBuilderDefaultInserter<true> {
165 InstCombineWorklist &Worklist;
166 public:
167 InstCombineIRInserter(InstCombineWorklist &WL) : Worklist(WL) {}
168
169 void InsertHelper(Instruction *I, const Twine &Name,
170 BasicBlock *BB, BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt) const {
171 IRBuilderDefaultInserter<true>::InsertHelper(I, Name, BB, InsertPt);
172 Worklist.Add(I);
173 }
174 };
175} // end anonymous namespace
176
177
178namespace {
Chris Lattner3e8b6632009-09-02 06:11:42 +0000179 class InstCombiner : public FunctionPass,
180 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000181 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +0000182 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +0000183 bool MadeIRChange;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000184 public:
Chris Lattner75551f72009-08-30 17:53:59 +0000185 /// Worklist - All of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000186 InstCombineWorklist Worklist;
187
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000188 /// Builder - This is an IRBuilder that automatically inserts new
189 /// instructions into the worklist when they are created.
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +0000190 typedef IRBuilder<true, TargetFolder, InstCombineIRInserter> BuilderTy;
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +0000191 BuilderTy *Builder;
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000192
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +0000193 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000194 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID), TD(0), Builder(0) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +0000195
Owen Andersone922c022009-07-22 00:24:57 +0000196 LLVMContext *Context;
197 LLVMContext *getContext() const { return Context; }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000198
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000199 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000200 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000201
202 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000203
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000204 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000205 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000206 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000207 }
208
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000209 TargetData *getTargetData() const { return TD; }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000210
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000211 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
212 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
213 // Return Value:
214 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000215 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000216 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000217 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000218 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000219 Instruction *visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000220 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000221 Instruction *visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000222 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000223 Instruction *visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000224 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
225 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
226 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000227 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000228 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
229 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000230 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
231 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
232 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
233 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
234 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +0000235 Instruction *FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +0000236 Instruction *FoldAndOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS, FCmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000237 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +0000238 Instruction *FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +0000239 Instruction *FoldOrOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS, FCmpInst *RHS);
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +0000240 Instruction *FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +0000241 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000242 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
243 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000244 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
245 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
246 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
247 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000248 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
249 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000250 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
251 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
252 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000253 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
254 Instruction *LHS,
255 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000256 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
257 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000258
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +0000259 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(GEPOperator *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000260 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000261 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000262 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000263 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
264 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000265 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000266 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
267 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
268 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000269 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000270 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000271 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
272 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000273 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
274 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000275 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(PtrToIntInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000276 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000277 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000278 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
279 Instruction *FI);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +0000280 Instruction *FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value*, Value*);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000281 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
282 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000283 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
284 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000285 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
286 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +0000287 Instruction *visitAllocaInst(AllocaInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000288 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Victor Hernandez66284e02009-10-24 04:23:03 +0000289 Instruction *visitFree(Instruction &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000290 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000291 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000292 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000293 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000294 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000295 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000296 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000297 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000298
299 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000300 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000301
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000302 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000303 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000304 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000305 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000306 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
307 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000308 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +0000309 DbgDeclareInst *hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V);
310
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000311
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000312 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000313 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
314 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
315 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000316 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000317 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
318 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000319 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
320 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000321 Worklist.Add(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000322 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000323 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000324
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000325 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
326 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
327 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
328 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
329 // modified.
330 //
331 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +0000332 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000333
334 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
335 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
336 if (&I == V)
337 V = UndefValue::get(I.getType());
338
339 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
340 return &I;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000341 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000342
343 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
344 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
345 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
346 // this function.
347 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +0000348 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ERASE " << I << '\n');
Chris Lattner931f8f32009-08-31 05:17:58 +0000349
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000350 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000351 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
352 // use counts.
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +0000353 if (I.getNumOperands() < 8) {
354 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
355 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
356 Worklist.Add(Op);
357 }
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000358 Worklist.Remove(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000359 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +0000360 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000361 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
362 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000363
364 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
365 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
366 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
367 }
368
369 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
370 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
371 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
372 }
373 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
374 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
375 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000376
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000377 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000378
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000379 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
380 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000381 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000382
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000383 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
384 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
385 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
386
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000387 /// SimplifyDemandedUseBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value
388 /// based on the demanded bits.
389 Value *SimplifyDemandedUseBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
390 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
391 unsigned Depth);
392 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Use &U, APInt DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000393 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000394 unsigned Depth=0);
395
396 /// SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits - Inst is an integer instruction that
397 /// SimplifyDemandedBits knows about. See if the instruction has any
398 /// properties that allow us to simplify its operands.
399 bool SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(Instruction &Inst);
400
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +0000401 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, APInt DemandedElts,
402 APInt& UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000403
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +0000404 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator, cast instruction, or select
405 // which has a PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction
406 // into the PHI (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are
407 // constants).
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +0000408 //
409 // If AllowAggressive is true, FoldOpIntoPhi will allow certain transforms
410 // that would normally be unprofitable because they strongly encourage jump
411 // threading.
412 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I, bool AllowAggressive = false);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000413
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000414 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
415 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
416 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
417 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000418 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +0000419 Instruction *FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
420
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000421
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000422 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
423 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000424
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000425 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000426 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000427 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000428 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +0000429 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocaInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000430 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000431 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000432 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000433 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000434
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000435
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000436 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000437
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000438 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +0000439 unsigned CastOpc, int &NumCastsRemoved);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000440 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
441 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000442
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000443 };
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000444} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000445
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000446char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
447static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
448X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
449
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000450// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000451// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Dan Gohman14ef4f02009-08-29 23:39:38 +0000452static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000453 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000454 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) ||
455 BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V) ||
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000456 BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000457 return 3;
458 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000459 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000460 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
461 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000462}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000463
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000464// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
465// it.
466static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000467 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000468}
469
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000470// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
471// though a va_arg area...
472static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000473 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
474 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000475 return Type::getInt32Ty(Ty->getContext());
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000476 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000477 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000478}
479
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000480/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
481/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
482/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000483static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
Dan Gohman016de812009-07-17 23:55:56 +0000484 if (Operator *O = dyn_cast<Operator>(V)) {
485 if (O->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
486 return O->getOperand(0);
487 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(V))
488 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
489 return GEP->getPointerOperand();
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000490 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000491 return 0;
492}
493
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000494/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
495/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000496static Instruction::CastOps
497isEliminableCastPair(
498 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
499 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
500 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
501 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
502) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000503
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000504 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
505 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000506
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000507 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
508 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
509 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000510
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000511 unsigned Res = CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000512 DstTy,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000513 TD ? TD->getIntPtrType(CI->getContext()) : 0);
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000514
515 // We don't want to form an inttoptr or ptrtoint that converts to an integer
516 // type that differs from the pointer size.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000517 if ((Res == Instruction::IntToPtr &&
Dan Gohman5e9bb732009-08-19 23:38:22 +0000518 (!TD || SrcTy != TD->getIntPtrType(CI->getContext()))) ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000519 (Res == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
Dan Gohman5e9bb732009-08-19 23:38:22 +0000520 (!TD || DstTy != TD->getIntPtrType(CI->getContext()))))
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000521 Res = 0;
522
523 return Instruction::CastOps(Res);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000524}
525
526/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
527/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
528/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000529static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
530 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000531 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
532
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000533 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000534 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000535 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000536 return false;
537 return true;
538}
539
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000540// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
541// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000542//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000543// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
544// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
545// binary operators.
546//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000547// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
548// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000549//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000550bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000551 bool Changed = false;
Dan Gohman14ef4f02009-08-29 23:39:38 +0000552 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000553 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000554
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000555 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
556 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000557 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
558 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
559 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000560 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000561 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
562 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000563 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
564 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
565 return true;
566 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
567 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
568 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
569 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
570 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
571
572 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000573 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000574 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000575 Op1->getOperand(0),
576 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000577 Worklist.Add(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000578 I.setOperand(0, New);
579 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
580 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000581 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000582 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000583 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000584}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000585
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000586/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
587/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
588/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
589bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
Dan Gohman14ef4f02009-08-29 23:39:38 +0000590 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000591 return false;
592 I.swapOperands();
593 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
594 return true;
595}
596
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000597// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
598// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000599//
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000600static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000601 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000602 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000603
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000604 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
605 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000606 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000607
608 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
609 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000610 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000611
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000612 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000613}
614
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000615// dyn_castFNegVal - Given a 'fsub' instruction, return the RHS of the
616// instruction if the LHS is a constant negative zero (which is the 'negate'
617// form).
618//
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000619static inline Value *dyn_castFNegVal(Value *V) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000620 if (BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000621 return BinaryOperator::getFNegArgument(V);
622
623 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
624 if (ConstantFP *C = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000625 return ConstantExpr::getFNeg(C);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000626
627 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
628 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isFloatingPoint())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000629 return ConstantExpr::getFNeg(C);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000630
631 return 0;
632}
633
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000634static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000635 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000636 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000637
638 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000639 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000640 return ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), ~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000641 return 0;
642}
643
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000644// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
645// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000646// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
647// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000648//
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000649static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000650 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000651 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000652 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000653 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000654 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000655 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000656 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000657 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000658 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000659 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000660 CST = ConstantInt::get(V->getType()->getContext(),
661 APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000662 return I->getOperand(0);
663 }
664 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000665 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000666}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000667
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000668/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000669static Constant *AddOne(Constant *C) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000670 return ConstantExpr::getAdd(C,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +0000671 ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000672}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000673/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000674static Constant *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000675 return ConstantExpr::getSub(C,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +0000676 ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000677}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000678/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
679/// this size.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000680static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000681 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
682 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
683 if (sign) {
684 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
685 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
686 } else {
687 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
688 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
689 }
690
691 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
692
693 if (sign) {
694 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
695 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
696 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
697 } else
698 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
699}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000700
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000701
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000702/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
703/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
704/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
705/// constant and return true.
706static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000707 APInt Demanded) {
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000708 assert(I && "No instruction?");
709 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
710
711 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
712 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
713 if (!OpC) return false;
714
715 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
716 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
717 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
718 return false;
719
720 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
721 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000722 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(OpC->getType(), Demanded));
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000723 return true;
724}
725
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000726// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
727// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
728// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
729// min/max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000730static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000731 const APInt& KnownOne,
732 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000733 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == KnownOne.getBitWidth() &&
734 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Min.getBitWidth() &&
735 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Max.getBitWidth() &&
736 "KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000737 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000738
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000739 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
740 // bit if it is unknown.
741 Min = KnownOne;
742 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
743
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000744 if (UnknownBits.isNegative()) { // Sign bit is unknown
745 Min.set(Min.getBitWidth()-1);
746 Max.clear(Max.getBitWidth()-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000747 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000748}
749
750// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
751// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
752// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
753// min/max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000754static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const APInt &KnownZero,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000755 const APInt &KnownOne,
756 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000757 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == KnownOne.getBitWidth() &&
758 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Min.getBitWidth() &&
759 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Max.getBitWidth() &&
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000760 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000761 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000762
763 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
764 Min = KnownOne;
765 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
766 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
767}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000768
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000769/// SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits - Inst is an integer instruction that
770/// SimplifyDemandedBits knows about. See if the instruction has any
771/// properties that allow us to simplify its operands.
772bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(Instruction &Inst) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000773 unsigned BitWidth = Inst.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000774 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
775 APInt DemandedMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
776
777 Value *V = SimplifyDemandedUseBits(&Inst, DemandedMask,
778 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0);
779 if (V == 0) return false;
780 if (V == &Inst) return true;
781 ReplaceInstUsesWith(Inst, V);
782 return true;
783}
784
785/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This form of SimplifyDemandedBits simplifies the
786/// specified instruction operand if possible, updating it in place. It returns
787/// true if it made any change and false otherwise.
788bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Use &U, APInt DemandedMask,
789 APInt &KnownZero, APInt &KnownOne,
790 unsigned Depth) {
791 Value *NewVal = SimplifyDemandedUseBits(U.get(), DemandedMask,
792 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
793 if (NewVal == 0) return false;
Dan Gohmane41a1152009-10-05 16:31:55 +0000794 U = NewVal;
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000795 return true;
796}
797
798
799/// SimplifyDemandedUseBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
800/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000801/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
802/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
803/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
804/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
805/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000806/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000807/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
808/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
809/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
810/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
811/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
812/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
813/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000814///
815/// This returns null if it did not change anything and it permits no
816/// simplification. This returns V itself if it did some simplification of V's
817/// operands based on the information about what bits are demanded. This returns
818/// some other non-null value if it found out that V is equal to another value
819/// in the context where the specified bits are demanded, but not for all users.
820Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedUseBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
821 APInt &KnownZero, APInt &KnownOne,
822 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000823 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
824 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
825 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000826 const Type *VTy = V->getType();
827 assert((TD || !isa<PointerType>(VTy)) &&
828 "SimplifyDemandedBits needs to know bit widths!");
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000829 assert((!TD || TD->getTypeSizeInBits(VTy->getScalarType()) == BitWidth) &&
830 (!VTy->isIntOrIntVector() ||
831 VTy->getScalarSizeInBits() == BitWidth) &&
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000832 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000833 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000834 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne "
835 "must have same BitWidth");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000836 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
837 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
838 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
839 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000840 return 0;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000841 }
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000842 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(V)) {
843 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
844 KnownOne.clear();
845 KnownZero = DemandedMask;
846 return 0;
847 }
848
Chris Lattner08d2cc72009-01-31 07:26:06 +0000849 KnownZero.clear();
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000850 KnownOne.clear();
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000851 if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
852 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
853 return 0;
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +0000854 return UndefValue::get(VTy);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000855 }
856
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000857 if (Depth == 6) // Limit search depth.
858 return 0;
859
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000860 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
861 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
862
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000863 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
864 if (!I) {
865 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
866 return 0; // Only analyze instructions.
867 }
868
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000869 // If there are multiple uses of this value and we aren't at the root, then
870 // we can't do any simplifications of the operands, because DemandedMask
871 // only reflects the bits demanded by *one* of the users.
872 if (Depth != 0 && !I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000873 // Despite the fact that we can't simplify this instruction in all User's
874 // context, we can at least compute the knownzero/knownone bits, and we can
875 // do simplifications that apply to *just* the one user if we know that
876 // this instruction has a simpler value in that context.
877 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
878 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
879 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
880 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
881 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
882 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
883
884 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
885 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and' in this
886 // context.
887 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
888 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
889 return I->getOperand(0);
890 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
891 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
892 return I->getOperand(1);
893
894 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
895 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +0000896 return Constant::getNullValue(VTy);
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000897
898 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
899 // We can simplify (X|Y) -> X or Y in the user's context if we know that
900 // only bits from X or Y are demanded.
901
902 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
903 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
904 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
905 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
906 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
907
908 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the
909 // other. These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or' in this
910 // context.
911 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
912 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
913 return I->getOperand(0);
914 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
915 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
916 return I->getOperand(1);
917
918 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
919 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
920 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
921 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
922 return I->getOperand(0);
923 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
924 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
925 return I->getOperand(1);
926 }
927
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000928 // Compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
929 ComputeMaskedBits(I, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
930 return 0;
931 }
932
933 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
934 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits so that we can try to simplify the
935 // operands. This allows visitTruncInst (for example) to simplify the
936 // operand of a trunc without duplicating all the logic below.
937 if (Depth == 0 && !V->hasOneUse())
938 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
939
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000940 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000941 default:
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000942 ComputeMaskedBits(I, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000943 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000944 case Instruction::And:
945 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000946 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
947 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
948 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000949 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000950 return I;
951 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
952 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000953
954 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
955 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
956 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
957 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000958 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000959 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
960 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000961 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000962
963 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
964 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +0000965 return Constant::getNullValue(VTy);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000966
967 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000968 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000969 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000970
971 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
972 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
973 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
974 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
975 break;
976 case Instruction::Or:
977 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000978 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
979 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
980 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000981 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000982 return I;
983 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
984 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000985
986 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
987 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
988 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
989 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000990 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000991 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
992 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000993 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000994
995 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
996 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
997 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
998 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000999 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001000 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
1001 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001002 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001003
1004 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001005 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001006 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001007
1008 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
1009 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1010 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
1011 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
1012 break;
1013 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001014 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
1015 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1016 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001017 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001018 return I;
1019 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1020 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001021
1022 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1023 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1024 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001025 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001026 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001027 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001028
1029 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1030 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1031 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1032 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1033 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1034 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1035
1036 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1037 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1038 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattner95afdfe2009-08-31 04:36:22 +00001039 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1040 Instruction *Or =
1041 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1042 I->getName());
1043 return InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1044 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001045
1046 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1047 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1048 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1049 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1050 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1051 // all known
1052 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
Dan Gohman43ee5f72009-08-03 22:07:33 +00001053 Constant *AndC = Constant::getIntegerValue(VTy,
1054 ~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001055 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001056 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001057 return InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001058 }
1059 }
1060
1061 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1062 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001063 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001064 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001065
Chris Lattnerd0883142009-10-11 22:22:13 +00001066 // If our LHS is an 'and' and if it has one use, and if any of the bits we
1067 // are flipping are known to be set, then the xor is just resetting those
1068 // bits to zero. We can just knock out bits from the 'and' and the 'xor',
1069 // simplifying both of them.
1070 if (Instruction *LHSInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I->getOperand(0)))
1071 if (LHSInst->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && LHSInst->hasOneUse() &&
1072 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)) &&
1073 isa<ConstantInt>(LHSInst->getOperand(1)) &&
1074 (LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask) != 0) {
1075 ConstantInt *AndRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSInst->getOperand(1));
1076 ConstantInt *XorRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1));
1077 APInt NewMask = ~(LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
1078
1079 Constant *AndC =
1080 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), NewMask & AndRHS->getValue());
1081 Instruction *NewAnd =
1082 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
1083 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, *I);
1084
1085 Constant *XorC =
1086 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), NewMask & XorRHS->getValue());
1087 Instruction *NewXor =
1088 BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, XorC, "tmp");
1089 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewXor, *I);
1090 }
1091
1092
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001093 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1094 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1095 break;
1096 }
1097 case Instruction::Select:
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001098 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(2), DemandedMask,
1099 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1100 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001101 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001102 return I;
1103 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1104 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001105
1106 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001107 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask) ||
1108 ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001109 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001110
1111 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1112 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1113 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1114 break;
1115 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001116 unsigned truncBf = I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001117 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1118 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1119 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001120 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001121 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001122 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001123 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1124 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1125 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001126 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001127 break;
1128 }
1129 case Instruction::BitCast:
Dan Gohman6cc18fe2009-07-01 21:38:46 +00001130 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isIntOrIntVector())
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001131 return false; // vector->int or fp->int?
Dan Gohman6cc18fe2009-07-01 21:38:46 +00001132
1133 if (const VectorType *DstVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getType())) {
1134 if (const VectorType *SrcVTy =
1135 dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
1136 if (DstVTy->getNumElements() != SrcVTy->getNumElements())
1137 // Don't touch a bitcast between vectors of different element counts.
1138 return false;
1139 } else
1140 // Don't touch a scalar-to-vector bitcast.
1141 return false;
1142 } else if (isa<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType()))
1143 // Don't touch a vector-to-scalar bitcast.
1144 return false;
1145
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001146 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001147 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001148 return I;
1149 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001150 break;
1151 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1152 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001153 unsigned SrcBitWidth =I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001154
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001155 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1156 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1157 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001158 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001159 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001160 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001161 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1162 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1163 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001164 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001165 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001166 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001167 break;
1168 }
1169 case Instruction::SExt: {
1170 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001171 unsigned SrcBitWidth =I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001172
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001173 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001174 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001175
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001176 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001177 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1178 // bit is demanded.
1179 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001180 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001181
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001182 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1183 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1184 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001185 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), InputDemandedBits,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001186 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001187 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001188 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1189 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1190 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001191 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001192
1193 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1194 // top bits of the result.
1195
1196 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1197 // convert this into a zero extension.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001198 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001199 // Convert to ZExt cast
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001200 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName());
1201 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *I);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001202 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001203 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001204 }
1205 break;
1206 }
1207 case Instruction::Add: {
1208 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1209 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1210 // either.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001211 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001212
1213 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1214 // we can do.
1215 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1216 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1217 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1218 if (RHS->isZero())
1219 break;
1220
1221 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1222 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001223 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001224
1225 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001226 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), InDemandedBits,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001227 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001228 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001229
1230 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1231 // the constant.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001232 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001233 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001234
1235 // Avoid excess work.
1236 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1237 break;
1238
1239 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1240 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1241 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001242 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001243 I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001244 return InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001245 }
1246
1247 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1248 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1249 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1250 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1251 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1252
1253 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1254 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1255 // this scan.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001256 const APInt &RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001257 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001258
1259 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1260
1261 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1262 // other, and there is no input carry.
1263 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1264 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1265
1266 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1267 // is no input carry.
1268 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1269 } else {
1270 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1271 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001272 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001273 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1274 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001275 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001276 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedFromOps,
1277 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1278 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedFromOps,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001279 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001280 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001281 }
1282 }
1283 break;
1284 }
1285 case Instruction::Sub:
1286 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1287 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001288 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001289 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1290 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001291 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001292 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001293 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedFromOps,
1294 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1295 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedFromOps,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001296 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001297 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001298 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001299 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1300 // the known zeros and ones.
1301 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001302 break;
1303 case Instruction::Shl:
1304 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001305 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001306 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001307 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001308 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001309 return I;
1310 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001311 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1312 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1313 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001314 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001315 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001316 }
1317 break;
1318 case Instruction::LShr:
1319 // For a logical shift right
1320 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001321 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001322
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001323 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001324 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001325 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001326 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001327 return I;
1328 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001329 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1330 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001331 if (ShiftAmt) {
1332 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001333 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001334 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1335 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001336 }
1337 break;
1338 case Instruction::AShr:
1339 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1340 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1341 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1342 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1343 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1344 // Perform the logical shift right.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001345 Instruction *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001346 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001347 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001348 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001349
1350 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1351 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1352 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001353 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001354
1355 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001356 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001357
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001358 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001359 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001360 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1361 // demanded.
1362 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1363 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001364 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001365 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001366 return I;
1367 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001368 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001369 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001370 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1371 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1372
1373 // Handle the sign bits.
1374 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1375 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1376 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1377
1378 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1379 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001380 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001381 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1382 // Perform the logical shift right.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001383 Instruction *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001384 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001385 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001386 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1387 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1388 }
1389 }
1390 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001391 case Instruction::SRem:
1392 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001393 APInt RA = Rem->getValue().abs();
1394 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
Eli Friedmana999a512009-06-17 02:57:36 +00001395 if (DemandedMask.ult(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001396 return I->getOperand(0);
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001397
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001398 APInt LowBits = RA - 1;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001399 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001400 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), Mask2,
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001401 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001402 return I;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001403
1404 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1405 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001406
1407 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001408
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001409 assert(!(KnownZero & KnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001410 }
1411 }
1412 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001413 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001414 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1415 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001416 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), AllOnes,
1417 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1) ||
1418 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001419 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001420 return I;
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001421
Chris Lattner455e9ab2009-01-21 18:09:24 +00001422 unsigned Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001423 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1424 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1425 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001426 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001427 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001428 case Instruction::Call:
1429 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1430 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1431 default: break;
1432 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1433 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1434 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1435 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1436 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1437
1438 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1439 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1440 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1441 NLZ &= ~7;
1442 NTZ &= ~7;
1443 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1444 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1445 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1446 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1447
1448 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1449 // the right place.
1450 Instruction *NewVal;
1451 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1452 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00001453 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001454 else
1455 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00001456 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001457 NewVal->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001458 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001459 }
1460
1461 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1462 break;
1463 }
1464 }
1465 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001466 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001467 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001468 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001469
1470 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1471 // constant.
Dan Gohman43ee5f72009-08-03 22:07:33 +00001472 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1473 return Constant::getIntegerValue(VTy, RHSKnownOne);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001474 return false;
1475}
1476
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001477
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001478/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value produces a vector with
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001479/// any number of elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001480/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1481/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1482///
1483/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1484/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1485/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001486Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, APInt DemandedElts,
1487 APInt& UndefElts,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001488 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001489 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001490 APInt EltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001491 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001492
1493 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1494 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1495 UndefElts = EltMask;
1496 return 0;
1497 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1498 UndefElts = EltMask;
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001499 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001500 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001501
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001502 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001503 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1504 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001505 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001506
1507 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1508 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001509 if (!DemandedElts[i]) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001510 Elts.push_back(Undef);
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001511 UndefElts.set(i);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001512 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1513 Elts.push_back(Undef);
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001514 UndefElts.set(i);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001515 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1516 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1517 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001518
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001519 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00001520 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001521 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1522 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001523 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001524 // set to undef.
Mon P Wange0b436a2008-11-06 22:52:21 +00001525
1526 // Check if this is identity. If so, return 0 since we are not simplifying
1527 // anything.
1528 if (DemandedElts == ((1ULL << VWidth) -1))
1529 return 0;
1530
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001531 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00001532 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001533 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001534 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001535 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
1536 Constant *Elt = DemandedElts[i] ? Zero : Undef;
1537 Elts.push_back(Elt);
1538 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001539 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00001540 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001541 }
1542
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001543 // Limit search depth.
1544 if (Depth == 10)
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001545 return 0;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001546
1547 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1548 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1549 // are needed.
1550 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1551 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1552 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1553 // the main instcombine process.
1554 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001555 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001556 return 0;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001557
1558 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1559 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001560 }
1561
1562 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001563 if (!I) return 0; // Only analyze instructions.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001564
1565 bool MadeChange = false;
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001566 APInt UndefElts2(VWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001567 Value *TmpV;
1568 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1569 default: break;
1570
1571 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1572 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1573 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001574 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001575 if (Idx == 0) {
1576 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1577 // which elt is getting updated.
1578 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1579 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1580 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1581 break;
1582 }
1583
1584 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1585 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001586 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerc3a3e362009-08-30 06:20:05 +00001587 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || !DemandedElts[IdxNo]) {
1588 Worklist.Add(I);
1589 return I->getOperand(0);
1590 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001591
1592 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1593 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001594 APInt DemandedElts2 = DemandedElts;
1595 DemandedElts2.clear(IdxNo);
1596 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts2,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001597 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1598 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1599
1600 // The inserted element is defined.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001601 UndefElts.clear(IdxNo);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001602 break;
1603 }
1604 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1605 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001606 uint64_t LHSVWidth =
1607 cast<VectorType>(Shuffle->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001608 APInt LeftDemanded(LHSVWidth, 0), RightDemanded(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001609 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001610 if (DemandedElts[i]) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001611 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1612 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001613 assert(MaskVal < LHSVWidth * 2 &&
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001614 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001615 if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001616 LeftDemanded.set(MaskVal);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001617 else
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001618 RightDemanded.set(MaskVal - LHSVWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001619 }
1620 }
1621 }
1622
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001623 APInt UndefElts4(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001624 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001625 UndefElts4, Depth+1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001626 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1627
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001628 APInt UndefElts3(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001629 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1630 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1631 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1632
1633 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1634 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1635 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001636 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001637 UndefElts.set(i);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001638 } else if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth) {
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001639 if (UndefElts4[MaskVal]) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001640 NewUndefElts = true;
1641 UndefElts.set(i);
1642 }
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001643 } else {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001644 if (UndefElts3[MaskVal - LHSVWidth]) {
1645 NewUndefElts = true;
1646 UndefElts.set(i);
1647 }
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001648 }
1649 }
1650
1651 if (NewUndefElts) {
1652 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1653 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1654 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001655 if (UndefElts[i])
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001656 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001657 else
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001658 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context),
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001659 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1660 }
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00001661 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001662 MadeChange = true;
1663 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001664 break;
1665 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001666 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001667 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001668 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1669 if (!VTy) break;
1670 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001671 APInt InputDemandedElts(InVWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001672 unsigned Ratio;
1673
1674 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001675 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001676 // elements as are demanded of us.
1677 Ratio = 1;
1678 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1679 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1680 // Untested so far.
1681 break;
1682
1683 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1684 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1685 // elements are live.
1686 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1687 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001688 if (DemandedElts[OutIdx])
1689 InputDemandedElts.set(OutIdx/Ratio);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001690 }
1691 } else {
1692 // Untested so far.
1693 break;
1694
1695 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1696 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1697 // live.
1698 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1699 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001700 if (DemandedElts[InIdx/Ratio])
1701 InputDemandedElts.set(InIdx);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001702 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001703
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001704 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1705 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1706 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1707 if (TmpV) {
1708 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1709 MadeChange = true;
1710 }
1711
1712 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1713 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001714 llvm_unreachable("Unimp");
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001715 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1716 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1717 // undef.
1718 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001719 if (UndefElts2[OutIdx/Ratio])
1720 UndefElts.set(OutIdx);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001721 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001722 llvm_unreachable("Unimp");
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001723 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1724 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1725 // elements are undef.
1726 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1727 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001728 if (!UndefElts2[InIdx]) // Not undef?
1729 UndefElts.clear(InIdx/Ratio); // Clear undef bit.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001730 }
1731 break;
1732 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001733 case Instruction::And:
1734 case Instruction::Or:
1735 case Instruction::Xor:
1736 case Instruction::Add:
1737 case Instruction::Sub:
1738 case Instruction::Mul:
1739 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1740 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1741 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1742 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1743 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1744 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1745 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1746
1747 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1748 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1749 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1750 break;
1751
1752 case Instruction::Call: {
1753 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1754 if (!II) break;
1755 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1756 default: break;
1757
1758 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1759 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1760 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1761 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1762 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1763 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1764 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1765 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1766 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1767 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1768 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1769 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1770 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1771 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1772 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1773 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1774
1775 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1776 // scalarize it now.
1777 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1778 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1779 default: break;
1780 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1781 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1782 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1783 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1784 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1785 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1786 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1787 // Extract the element as scalars.
Eric Christophera3500da2009-07-25 02:28:41 +00001788 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(ExtractElementInst::Create(LHS,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001789 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0U, false), "tmp"), *II);
Eric Christophera3500da2009-07-25 02:28:41 +00001790 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(ExtractElementInst::Create(RHS,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001791 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0U, false), "tmp"), *II);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001792
1793 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001794 default: llvm_unreachable("Case stmts out of sync!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001795 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1796 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00001797 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001798 II->getName()), *II);
1799 break;
1800 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1801 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00001802 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001803 II->getName()), *II);
1804 break;
1805 }
1806
1807 Instruction *New =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001808 InsertElementInst::Create(
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001809 UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001810 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0U, false), II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001811 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001812 return New;
1813 }
1814 }
1815
1816 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1817 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1818 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1819 break;
1820 }
1821 break;
1822 }
1823 }
1824 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1825}
1826
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001827
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001828/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1829/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1830/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1831/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1832/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1833/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1834/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1835///
1836template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001837static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001838 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1839 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1840
1841 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1842 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1843 return F.apply(Root);
1844
1845 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1846 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001847 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001848 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1849 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1850
1851 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1852 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1853 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1854 ShouldApply = true;
1855 }
1856
1857 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1858 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1859 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001860 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1861 // and perform the reassociation.
1862 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1863
1864 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1865 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1866
1867 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1868 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001869 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00001870 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001871 return 0;
1872 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001873 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001874 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001875 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001876 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001877 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001878
1879 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1880 // get to LHSI.
1881 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1882 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001883 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1884 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001885 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001886 ARI = NextLHSI;
1887
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001888 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1889 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1890 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1891 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1892 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001893
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001894 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1895 // the transformation...
1896 return F.apply(Root);
1897 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001898
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001899 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1900 }
1901 return 0;
1902}
1903
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001904namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001905
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001906// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001907struct AddRHS {
1908 Value *RHS;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00001909 explicit AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001910 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1911 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001912 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00001913 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001914 }
1915};
1916
1917// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1918// iff C1&C2 == 0
1919struct AddMaskingAnd {
1920 Constant *C2;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00001921 explicit AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001922 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001923 ConstantInt *C1;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00001924 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00001925 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001926 }
1927 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001928 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001929 }
1930};
1931
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001932}
1933
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001934static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001935 InstCombiner *IC) {
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00001936 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I))
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00001937 return IC->Builder->CreateCast(CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType());
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001938
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001939 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001940 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1941 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001942
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001943 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1944 if (ConstIsRHS)
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00001945 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1946 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001947 }
1948
1949 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1950 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1951 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00001952
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001953 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00001954 return IC->Builder->CreateBinOp(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,
1955 SO->getName()+".op");
1956 if (ICmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(&I))
1957 return IC->Builder->CreateICmp(CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1958 SO->getName()+".cmp");
1959 if (FCmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(&I))
1960 return IC->Builder->CreateICmp(CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1961 SO->getName()+".cmp");
1962 llvm_unreachable("Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001963}
1964
1965// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1966// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1967// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1968// not have a second operand.
1969static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1970 InstCombiner *IC) {
1971 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1972 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1973 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1974 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1975
1976 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001977 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001978 if (SI->getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*IC->getContext())) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001979
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001980 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1981 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1982
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001983 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1984 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001985 }
1986 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001987}
1988
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001989
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00001990/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator, cast instruction, or select which
1991/// has a PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the
1992/// PHI (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00001993///
1994/// If AllowAggressive is true, FoldOpIntoPhi will allow certain transforms
1995/// that would normally be unprofitable because they strongly encourage jump
1996/// threading.
1997Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I,
1998 bool AllowAggressive) {
1999 AllowAggressive = false;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002000 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00002001 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00002002 if (NumPHIValues == 0 ||
2003 // We normally only transform phis with a single use, unless we're trying
2004 // hard to make jump threading happen.
2005 (!PN->hasOneUse() && !AllowAggressive))
2006 return 0;
2007
2008
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002009 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are simple constants
2010 // (constantint/constantfp/undef). If there is one non-constant value,
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002011 // remember the BB it is in. If there is more than one or if *it* is a PHI,
2012 // bail out. We don't do arbitrary constant expressions here because moving
2013 // their computation can be expensive without a cost model.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002014 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
2015 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002016 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i)) ||
2017 isa<ConstantExpr>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002018 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00002019 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002020 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
2021
2022 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
2023 // loop.
2024 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
2025 return 0;
2026 }
2027
2028 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
2029 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
2030 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
2031 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00002032 if (NonConstBB != 0 && !AllowAggressive) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002033 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
2034 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
2035 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002036
2037 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002038 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00002039 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner857eb572009-10-21 23:41:58 +00002040 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
2041 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002042
2043 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002044 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(&I)) {
2045 // We only currently try to fold the condition of a select when it is a phi,
2046 // not the true/false values.
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002047 Value *TrueV = SI->getTrueValue();
2048 Value *FalseV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner3ddfb212009-09-28 06:49:44 +00002049 BasicBlock *PhiTransBB = PN->getParent();
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002050 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002051 BasicBlock *ThisBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
Chris Lattner3ddfb212009-09-28 06:49:44 +00002052 Value *TrueVInPred = TrueV->DoPHITranslation(PhiTransBB, ThisBB);
2053 Value *FalseVInPred = FalseV->DoPHITranslation(PhiTransBB, ThisBB);
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002054 Value *InV = 0;
2055 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002056 InV = InC->isNullValue() ? FalseVInPred : TrueVInPred;
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002057 } else {
2058 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002059 InV = SelectInst::Create(PN->getIncomingValue(i), TrueVInPred,
2060 FalseVInPred,
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002061 "phitmp", NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner857eb572009-10-21 23:41:58 +00002062 Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002063 }
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002064 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, ThisBB);
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002065 }
2066 } else if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002067 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00002068 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00002069 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002070 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002071 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002072 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002073 else
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002074 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002075 } else {
2076 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
2077 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002078 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002079 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
2080 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002081 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00002082 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002083 CI->getPredicate(),
2084 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
2085 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002086 else
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00002087 llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
Chris Lattner857eb572009-10-21 23:41:58 +00002088
2089 Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002090 }
2091 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002092 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002093 } else {
2094 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
2095 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00002096 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002097 Value *InV;
2098 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002099 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002100 } else {
2101 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002102 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002103 I.getType(), "phitmp",
2104 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner857eb572009-10-21 23:41:58 +00002105 Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002106 }
2107 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002108 }
2109 }
2110 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
2111}
2112
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002113
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002114/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
2115/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
2116/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
2117/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
2118bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2119 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
2120 // ones.
2121
2122 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
2123 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
2124 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
2125 // sign extend fine.
2126 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
2127 return true;
2128
2129
2130 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
2131 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
2132 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
2133 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
2134
2135 // TODO: Implement.
2136
2137 return false;
2138}
2139
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002140
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002141Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002142 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002143 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002144
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002145 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002146 // X + undef -> undef
2147 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
2148 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
2149
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002150 // X + 0 --> X
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002151 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
2152 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002153
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002154 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002155 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002156 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002157 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002158 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002159 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002160
2161 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2162 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002163 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00002164 return &I;
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002165
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002166 // zext(bool) + C -> bool ? C + 1 : C
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002167 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002168 if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002169 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), AddOne(CI), CI);
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002170 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002171
2172 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2173 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2174 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002175
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002176 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2177 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002178 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002179 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002180 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002181 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002182
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002183 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002184 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2185 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002186 do {
2187 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002188 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2189 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002190 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2191 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002192 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002193 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2194 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002195 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002196 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002197 }
2198 }
2199 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002200 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2201 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2202 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002203
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002204 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002205 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2206 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2207 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002208 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2209 switch (Size) {
2210 default: break;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002211 case 32: MiddleType = Type::getInt32Ty(*Context); break;
2212 case 16: MiddleType = Type::getInt16Ty(*Context); break;
2213 case 8: MiddleType = Type::getInt8Ty(*Context); break;
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002214 }
2215 if (MiddleType) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002216 Value *NewTrunc = Builder->CreateTrunc(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002217 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002218 }
2219 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002220 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002221
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002222 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002223 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2224
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002225 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002226 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002227 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002228 return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002229
2230 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2231 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2232 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2233 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2234 }
2235 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2236 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2237 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2238 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2239 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002240 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002241
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002242 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002243 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002244 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002245 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002246 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002247 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002248 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002249 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002250 }
2251
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002252 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002253 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002254
2255 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002256 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002257 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002258 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002259
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002260
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002261 ConstantInt *C2;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002262 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002263 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002264 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002265
2266 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2267 ConstantInt *C1;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002268 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002269 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, ConstantExpr::getAdd(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002270 }
2271
2272 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002273 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
2274 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002275
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002276 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002277 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS ||
2278 dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002279 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002280
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002281
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002282 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002283 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
2284 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002285 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002286
2287 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2288 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2289 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2290 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2291 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2292 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2293 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2294 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2295 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2296 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2297
2298 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002299 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002300 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002301 }
2302 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002303
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002304 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002305 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002306 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002307 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2308 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002309 if (W != Y) {
2310 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002311 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002312 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002313 std::swap(W, X);
2314 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002315 std::swap(Y, Z);
2316 std::swap(W, X);
2317 }
2318 }
2319
2320 if (W == Y) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002321 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(X, Z, LHS->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002322 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002323 }
2324 }
2325 }
2326
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002327 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002328 Value *X = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002329 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002330 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002331
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002332 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002333 if (LHS->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002334 match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002335 Constant *Anded = ConstantExpr::getAnd(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002336 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2337 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2338 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002339 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002340
2341 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002342 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002343
2344 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002345 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002346
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002347 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2348 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002349 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(X, CRHS, LHS->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002350 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002351 }
2352 }
2353 }
2354
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002355 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2356 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002357 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002358 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002359 }
2360
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002361 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002362 {
2363 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002364 Value *A = RHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002365 if (!SI) {
2366 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002367 A = LHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002368 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002369 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002370 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2371 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002372 Value *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002373
2374 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2375 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002376 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) &&
2377 match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002378 // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002379 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002380 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) &&
2381 match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002382 // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002383 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002384 }
2385 }
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002386
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002387 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2388 // integer add followed by a sext.
2389 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2390 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2391 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2392 Constant *CI =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002393 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002394 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002395 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002396 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2397 // Insert the new, smaller add.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002398 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2399 CI, "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002400 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2401 }
2402 }
2403
2404 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2405 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2406 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2407 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2408 // integer add will not overflow.
2409 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2410 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2411 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2412 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2413 // Insert the new integer add.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002414 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2415 RHSConv->getOperand(0), "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002416 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2417 }
2418 }
2419 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002420
2421 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2422}
2423
2424Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
2425 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
2426 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
2427
2428 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
2429 // X + 0 --> X
2430 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Owen Anderson6f83c9c2009-07-27 20:59:43 +00002431 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002432 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
2433 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2434 }
2435
2436 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2437 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2438 return NV;
2439 }
2440
2441 // -A + B --> B - A
2442 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002443 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castFNegVal(LHS))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002444 return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(RHS, LHSV);
2445
2446 // A + -B --> A - B
2447 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002448 if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(RHS))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002449 return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, V);
2450
2451 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2452 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2453 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2454 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2455
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002456 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2457 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2458 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2459 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2460 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2461 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2462 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2463 // instcombined.
2464 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2465 Constant *CI =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002466 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002467 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002468 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002469 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2470 // Insert the new integer add.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002471 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2472 CI, "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002473 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2474 }
2475 }
2476
2477 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2478 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2479 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2480 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2481 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2482 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2483 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2484 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2485 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2486 // Insert the new integer add.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002487 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2488 RHSConv->getOperand(0), "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002489 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2490 }
2491 }
2492 }
2493
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002494 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002495}
2496
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002497Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002498 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002499
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002500 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002501 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002502
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002503 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002504 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002505 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002506
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002507 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2508 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2509 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2510 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2511
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002512 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2513 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002514 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002515 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002516
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002517 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002518 Value *X = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002519 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002520 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002521
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002522 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2523 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002524 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002525 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002526 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002527 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002528 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002529 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002530 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002531 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002532 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002533 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002534 }
2535 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002536 }
2537 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2538 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2539 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002540 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002541 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002542 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002543 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002544 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002545 }
2546 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002547 }
2548 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002549 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002550
2551 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2552 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002553 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002554 return R;
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002555
2556 // C - zext(bool) -> bool ? C - 1 : C
2557 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op1))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002558 if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002559 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), SubOne(C), C);
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002560 }
2561
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002562 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002563 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2564
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002565 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002566 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002567 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002568 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002569 I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002570 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002571 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002572 I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002573 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2574 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2575 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002576 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002577 ConstantExpr::getSub(CI1, CI2), Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002578 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002579 }
2580
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002581 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002582 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2583 // is not used by anyone else...
2584 //
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002585 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002586 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2587 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2588 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2589 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002590
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002591 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002592 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002593 }
2594
2595 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2596 //
2597 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2598 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2599 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2600
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002601 Value *NewNot = Builder->CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002602 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002603 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002604
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002605 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002606 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002607 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002608 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002609 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002610 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002611 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002612
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002613 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002614 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002615 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002616 Constant *CP1 =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002617 ConstantExpr::getSub(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002618 C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002619 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002620 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002621 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002622 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002623
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002624 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
2625 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
2626 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2627 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2628 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2629 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
2630 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2631 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002632 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002633 I.getName());
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002634 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002635 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002636
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002637 ConstantInt *C1;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002638 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002639 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002640 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002641
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002642 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002643 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002644 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, ConstantExpr::getSub(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002645 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002646 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002647}
2648
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002649Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
2650 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2651
2652 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002653 if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(Op1))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002654 return BinaryOperator::CreateFAdd(Op0, V);
2655
2656 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2657 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd) {
2658 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002659 return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002660 I.getName());
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002661 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002662 return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002663 I.getName());
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002664 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002665 }
2666
2667 return 0;
2668}
2669
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002670/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2671/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2672/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2673/// signed.
2674static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2675 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002676 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002677 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2678 TrueIfSigned = true;
2679 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002680 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2681 TrueIfSigned = true;
2682 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002683 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2684 TrueIfSigned = false;
2685 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002686 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2687 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2688 TrueIfSigned = true;
2689 return RHS->getValue() ==
2690 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2691 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2692 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2693 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002694 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002695 default:
2696 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002697 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002698}
2699
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002700Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002701 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002702 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002703
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002704 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // undef * X -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002705 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002706
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00002707 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS.
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002708 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
2709 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1C)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002710
2711 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002712 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002713 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2714 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002715 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002716 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002717
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002718 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002719 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1C); // X * 0 == 0
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002720 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2721 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2722 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002723 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002724
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002725 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002726 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002727 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00002728 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002729 }
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002730 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1C->getType())) {
2731 if (Op1C->isNullValue())
2732 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1C);
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002733
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002734 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1C)) {
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002735 if (Op1V->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002736 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002737
2738 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2739 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002740 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Splat))
2741 if (CI->equalsInt(1))
2742 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2743 }
2744 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002745 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002746
2747 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2748 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002749 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1C)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002750 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002751 Value *Add = Builder->CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op1C, "tmp");
2752 Value *C1C2 = Builder->CreateMul(Op1C, Op0I->getOperand(1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002753 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002754
2755 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002756
2757 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2758 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002759 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002760 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002761
2762 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2763 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2764 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002765 }
2766
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002767 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002768 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002769 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002770
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002771 // (X / Y) * Y = X - (X % Y)
2772 // (X / Y) * -Y = (X % Y) - X
2773 {
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002774 Value *Op1C = Op1;
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002775 BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
2776 if (!BO ||
2777 (BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::UDiv &&
2778 BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::SDiv)) {
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002779 Op1C = Op0;
2780 BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002781 }
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002782 Value *Neg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1C);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002783 if (BO && BO->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002784 (BO->getOperand(1) == Op1C || BO->getOperand(1) == Neg) &&
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002785 (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv ||
2786 BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)) {
2787 Value *Op0BO = BO->getOperand(0), *Op1BO = BO->getOperand(1);
2788
Dan Gohmanfa94b942009-08-12 16:33:09 +00002789 // If the division is exact, X % Y is zero.
2790 if (SDivOperator *SDiv = dyn_cast<SDivOperator>(BO))
2791 if (SDiv->isExact()) {
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002792 if (Op1BO == Op1C)
Dan Gohmanfa94b942009-08-12 16:33:09 +00002793 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0BO);
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002794 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0BO);
Dan Gohmanfa94b942009-08-12 16:33:09 +00002795 }
2796
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002797 Value *Rem;
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002798 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002799 Rem = Builder->CreateURem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002800 else
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002801 Rem = Builder->CreateSRem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002802 Rem->takeName(BO);
2803
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002804 if (Op1BO == Op1C)
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002805 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Op0BO, Rem);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002806 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Rem, Op0BO);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002807 }
2808 }
2809
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00002810 /// i1 mul -> i1 and.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002811 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002812 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Op1);
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002813
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00002814 // X*(1 << Y) --> X << Y
2815 // (1 << Y)*X --> X << Y
2816 {
2817 Value *Y;
2818 if (match(Op0, m_Shl(m_One(), m_Value(Y))))
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002819 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op1, Y);
2820 if (match(Op1, m_Shl(m_One(), m_Value(Y))))
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00002821 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0, Y);
2822 }
2823
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002824 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2825 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
Chris Lattnerd2c58362009-10-11 21:29:45 +00002826 // X * Y (where Y is 0 or 1) -> X & (0-Y)
2827 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2828 // -2 is "-1 << 1" so it is all bits set except the low one.
Dale Johannesenc1deda52009-10-12 18:45:32 +00002829 APInt Negative2(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), (uint64_t)-2, true);
Chris Lattner0036e3a2009-10-11 21:22:21 +00002830
Chris Lattnerd2c58362009-10-11 21:29:45 +00002831 Value *BoolCast = 0, *OtherOp = 0;
2832 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Negative2))
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002833 BoolCast = Op0, OtherOp = Op1;
2834 else if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Negative2))
2835 BoolCast = Op1, OtherOp = Op0;
Chris Lattnerd2c58362009-10-11 21:29:45 +00002836
Chris Lattner0036e3a2009-10-11 21:22:21 +00002837 if (BoolCast) {
Chris Lattner0036e3a2009-10-11 21:22:21 +00002838 Value *V = Builder->CreateSub(Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
2839 BoolCast, "tmp");
2840 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002841 }
2842 }
2843
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002844 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002845}
2846
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002847Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
2848 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002849 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002850
2851 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002852 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
2853 if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1C)) {
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002854 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2855 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
2856 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2857 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002858 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1C->getType())) {
2859 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1C)) {
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002860 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2861 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
2862 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Splat))
2863 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2864 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2865 }
2866 }
2867 }
2868
2869 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2870 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2871 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2872 return R;
2873
2874 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2875 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2876 return NV;
2877 }
2878
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002879 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castFNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
Chris Lattnera2498472009-10-11 21:36:10 +00002880 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castFNegVal(Op1))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002881 return BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(Op0v, Op1v);
2882
2883 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2884}
2885
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002886/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2887/// instruction.
2888bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2889 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2890
2891 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2892 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2893 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2894 if (ST->isNullValue())
2895 NonNullOperand = 2;
2896 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2897 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2898 if (ST->isNullValue())
2899 NonNullOperand = 1;
2900
2901 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2902 return false;
2903
2904 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2905
2906 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2907 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2908
2909 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2910 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2911 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2912 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2913 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2914
2915 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2916 // early exit.
2917 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2918 return true;
2919
2920 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2921 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2922
2923 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2924 --BBI;
2925 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2926 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2927 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2928 break;
2929
2930 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2931 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2932 I != E; ++I) {
2933 if (*I == SI) {
2934 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00002935 Worklist.Add(BBI);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002936 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00002937 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context) :
2938 ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00002939 Worklist.Add(BBI);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002940 }
2941 }
2942
2943 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2944 if (&*BBI == SI)
2945 SI = 0;
2946 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2947 SelectCond = 0;
2948
2949 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2950 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2951 break;
2952
2953 }
2954 return true;
2955}
2956
2957
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002958/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2959/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2960/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2961/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002962Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002963 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002964
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002965 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2966 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2967 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2968 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2969 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002970 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002971 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002972
2973 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002974 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002975 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002976
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002977 return 0;
2978}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002979
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002980/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2981/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2982/// division instructions.
2983/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002984Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002985 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2986
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002987 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002988 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2989 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00002990 Constant *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002991 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00002992 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002993 }
2994
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00002995 Constant *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2997 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002998
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002999 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
3000 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00003001
3002 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
3003 // This does not apply for fdiv.
3004 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
3005 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003006
3007 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3008 // div X, 1 == X
3009 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
3010 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3011
3012 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
3013 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
3014 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
3015 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003016 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003017 I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003018 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00003019 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003020 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003021 ConstantExpr::getMul(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00003022 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003023
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003024 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003025 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
3026 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
3027 return R;
3028 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3029 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3030 return NV;
3031 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003032 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003033
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003034 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003035 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003036 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003037 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003038
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00003039 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00003040 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00003041 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3042
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00003043 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3044 if (ConstantInt *X = cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
3045 // div X, 1 == X
3046 if (X->isOne())
3047 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3048 }
3049
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003050 return 0;
3051}
3052
3053Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3054 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3055
3056 // Handle the integer div common cases
3057 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
3058 return Common;
3059
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003060 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003061 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
3062 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
3063 // if so, convert to a right shift.
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003064 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003065 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003066 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003067
3068 // X udiv C, where C >= signbit
3069 if (C->getValue().isNegative()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003070 Value *IC = Builder->CreateICmpULT( Op0, C);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003071 return SelectInst::Create(IC, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003072 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003073 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003074 }
3075
3076 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003077 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003078 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3079 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003080 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003081 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003082 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003083 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003084 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2())
3085 N = Builder->CreateAdd(N, ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2), "tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003086 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003087 }
3088 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00003089 }
3090
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003091 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
3092 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003093 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003094 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003095 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003096 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003097 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003098 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003099 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003100 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003101 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003102 Value *TSI = Builder->CreateLShr(Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003103
3104 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003105 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003106 Value *FSI = Builder->CreateLShr(Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003107
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003108 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003109 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003110 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003111 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003112 return 0;
3113}
3114
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003115Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3116 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3117
3118 // Handle the integer div common cases
3119 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
3120 return Common;
3121
3122 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3123 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
3124 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003125 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Dan Gohman1bdf5dc2009-08-11 20:47:47 +00003126
Dan Gohmanfa94b942009-08-12 16:33:09 +00003127 // sdiv X, C --> ashr X, log2(C)
Dan Gohman1bdf5dc2009-08-11 20:47:47 +00003128 if (cast<SDivOperator>(&I)->isExact() &&
3129 RHS->getValue().isNonNegative() &&
3130 RHS->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3131 Value *ShAmt = llvm::ConstantInt::get(RHS->getType(),
3132 RHS->getValue().exactLogBase2());
3133 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(Op0, ShAmt, I.getName());
3134 }
Dan Gohman9ca9daa2009-08-12 16:37:02 +00003135
3136 // -X/C --> X/-C provided the negation doesn't overflow.
3137 if (SubOperator *Sub = dyn_cast<SubOperator>(Op0))
3138 if (isa<Constant>(Sub->getOperand(0)) &&
3139 cast<Constant>(Sub->getOperand(0))->isNullValue() &&
Dan Gohman5078f842009-08-20 17:11:38 +00003140 Sub->hasNoSignedWrap())
Dan Gohman9ca9daa2009-08-12 16:37:02 +00003141 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Sub->getOperand(1),
3142 ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003143 }
3144
3145 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
3146 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003147 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003148 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003149 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3150 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask)) {
3151 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
3152 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
3153 }
3154 ConstantInt *ShiftedInt;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003155 if (match(Op1, m_Shl(m_ConstantInt(ShiftedInt), m_Value())) &&
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003156 ShiftedInt->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3157 // X sdiv (1 << Y) -> X udiv (1 << Y) ( -> X u>> Y)
3158 // Safe because the only negative value (1 << Y) can take on is
3159 // INT_MIN, and X sdiv INT_MIN == X udiv INT_MIN == 0 if X doesn't have
3160 // the sign bit set.
3161 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
3162 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003163 }
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003164 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003165
3166 return 0;
3167}
3168
3169Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3170 return commonDivTransforms(I);
3171}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003172
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003173/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
3174/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
3175/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
3176/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
3177Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003178 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003179
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003180 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
3181 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
3182 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003183 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003184 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003185 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
3186 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003187
3188 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00003189 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
3190 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00003191
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003192 return 0;
3193}
3194
3195/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
3196/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
3197/// remainder instructions.
3198/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
3199Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
3200 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3201
3202 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
3203 return common;
3204
Dale Johannesened6af242009-01-21 00:35:19 +00003205 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
3206 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
3207 if (LHS->isNullValue())
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003208 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Dale Johannesened6af242009-01-21 00:35:19 +00003209
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003210 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003211 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
3212 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00003213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003214
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003215 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003216 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003217
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003218 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
3219 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
3220 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
3221 return R;
3222 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
3223 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3224 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003225 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003226
3227 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00003228 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003229 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003230 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003231 }
3232
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003233 return 0;
3234}
3235
3236Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3237 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3238
3239 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3240 return common;
3241
3242 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3243 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
3244 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
3245 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
3246 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003247 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003248 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003249 }
3250
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003251 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003252 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
3253 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3254 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003255 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003256 Constant *N1 = Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003257 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(RHSI, N1, "tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003258 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003259 }
3260 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003261 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003262
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003263 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3264 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3265 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3266 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3267 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3268 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003269 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3270 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003271 Value *TrueAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO),
3272 SI->getName()+".t");
3273 Value *FalseAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO),
3274 SI->getName()+".f");
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003275 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003276 }
3277 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003278 }
3279
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003280 return 0;
3281}
3282
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003283Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3284 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3285
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003286 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +00003287 if (Instruction *Common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3288 return Common;
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003289
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003290 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003291 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3292 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3293 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003294 // X % -Y -> X % Y
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +00003295 Worklist.AddValue(I.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003296 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3297 return &I;
3298 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003299
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003300 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003301 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003302 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3303 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3304 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3305 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003306 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003307 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003308 }
3309
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003310 // If it's a constant vector, flip any negative values positive.
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003311 if (ConstantVector *RHSV = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3312 unsigned VWidth = RHSV->getNumOperands();
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003313
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003314 bool hasNegative = false;
3315 for (unsigned i = 0; !hasNegative && i != VWidth; ++i)
3316 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i)))
3317 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
3318 hasNegative = true;
3319
3320 if (hasNegative) {
3321 std::vector<Constant *> Elts(VWidth);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003322 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
3323 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i))) {
3324 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003325 Elts[i] = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003326 else
3327 Elts[i] = RHS;
3328 }
3329 }
3330
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00003331 Constant *NewRHSV = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003332 if (NewRHSV != RHSV) {
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +00003333 Worklist.AddValue(I.getOperand(1));
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003334 I.setOperand(1, NewRHSV);
3335 return &I;
3336 }
3337 }
3338 }
3339
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003340 return 0;
3341}
3342
3343Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003344 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3345}
3346
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003347// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3348// constant.
3349static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003350 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003351}
3352
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003353// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3354// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3355static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003356 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003357}
3358
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003359/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003360/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3361///
3362/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3363///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003364/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3365/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003366///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003367/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3368/// 0 A > B
3369/// 1 A == B
3370/// 2 A < B
3371///
3372/// <=> Value Definition
3373/// 000 0 Always false
3374/// 001 1 A > B
3375/// 010 2 A == B
3376/// 011 3 A >= B
3377/// 100 4 A < B
3378/// 101 5 A != B
3379/// 110 6 A <= B
3380/// 111 7 Always true
3381///
3382static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3383 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003384 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003385 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3386 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3387 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3388 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3389 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3390 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3391 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3392 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3393 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3394 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003395 // True -> 7
3396 default:
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003397 llvm_unreachable("Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003398 return 0;
3399 }
3400}
3401
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003402/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3403/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3404/// predicate by reference.
3405static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3406 isOrdered = false;
3407 switch (CC) {
3408 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3409 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003410 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3411 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3412 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3413 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003414 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3415 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3416 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3417 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003418 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3419 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003420 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3421 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003422 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003423 default:
3424 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003425 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003426 return 0;
3427 }
3428}
3429
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003430/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3431/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003432/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003433/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003434static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00003435 LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003436 switch (code) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003437 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal ICmp code!");
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003438 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003439 case 1:
3440 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003441 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003442 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003443 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3444 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003445 case 3:
3446 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003447 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003448 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003449 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003450 case 4:
3451 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003452 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003453 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003454 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3455 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003456 case 6:
3457 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003458 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003459 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003460 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003461 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003462 }
3463}
3464
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003465/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3466/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3467/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3468static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00003469 Value *LHS, Value *RHS, LLVMContext *Context) {
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003470 switch (code) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003471 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003472 case 0:
3473 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003474 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003475 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003476 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003477 case 1:
3478 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003479 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003480 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003481 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003482 case 2:
3483 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003484 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003485 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003486 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003487 case 3:
3488 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003489 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003490 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003491 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003492 case 4:
3493 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003494 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003495 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003496 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003497 case 5:
3498 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003499 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003500 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003501 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003502 case 6:
3503 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003504 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003505 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003506 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003507 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003508 }
3509}
3510
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003511/// PredicatesFoldable - Return true if both predicates match sign or if at
3512/// least one of them is an equality comparison (which is signless).
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003513static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3514 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003515 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p2)) ||
3516 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003517}
3518
3519namespace {
3520// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3521struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003522 InstCombiner &IC;
3523 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003524 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3525 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3526 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3527 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003528 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003529 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3530 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003531 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3532 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003533 return false;
3534 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003535 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3536 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3537 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3538 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3539 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003540 }
3541
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003542 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003543 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003544 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003545 unsigned Code;
3546 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3547 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3548 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3549 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003550 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003551 }
3552
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003553 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3554 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3555
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003556 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS, IC.getContext());
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003557 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3558 return I;
3559 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3560 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3561 }
3562};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003563} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003564
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003565// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3566// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003567// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003568Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003569 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3570 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003571 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3572 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003573 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003574 if (!Op->isShift())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003575 Together = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003576
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003577 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3578 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003579 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003580 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003581 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003582 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003583 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003584 }
3585 break;
3586 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003587 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3588 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003589
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003590 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3591 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003592 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003593 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003594 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003595 }
3596 break;
3597 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003598 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003599 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3600 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3601 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003602 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003603
3604 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003605 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003606 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3607 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3608 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003609 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003610
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003611 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3612 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3613 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3614 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3615 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3616 // no effect.
3617 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3618 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3619 return &TheAnd;
3620 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003621 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003622 Value *NewAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003623 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003624 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003625 }
3626 }
3627 }
3628 }
3629 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003630
3631 case Instruction::Shl: {
3632 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3633 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3634 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003635 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003636 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003637 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003638 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(*Context, AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003639
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003640 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3641 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003642 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3643 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003644 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3645 return &TheAnd;
3646 }
3647 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003648 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003649 case Instruction::LShr:
3650 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003651 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3652 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3653 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3654 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003655 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003656 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003657 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003658 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(*Context, AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003659
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003660 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3661 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3663 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3664 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3665 return &TheAnd;
3666 }
3667 break;
3668 }
3669 case Instruction::AShr:
3670 // Signed shr.
3671 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3672 // with an and.
3673 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003674 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003675 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003676 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003677 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(*Context, AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003678 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003679 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003680 // Make the argument unsigned.
3681 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003682 ShVal = Builder->CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS, Op->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003683 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003684 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003685 }
3686 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003687 }
3688 return 0;
3689}
3690
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003691
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003692/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3693/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003694/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3695/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003696/// insert new instructions.
3697Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003698 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3699 Instruction &IB) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003700 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003701 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003702 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003703
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003704 if (Inside) {
3705 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003706 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003707
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003708 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003709 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003710 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003711 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003712 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003713 }
3714
3715 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003716 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003717 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003718 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003719 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003720 }
3721
3722 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003723 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003724
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003725 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003726 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003727 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003728 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3729 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003730 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003731 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003732
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003733 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3734 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003735 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003736 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003737 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003738 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003739}
3740
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003741// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3742// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3743// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3744// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003745static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003746 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003747 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3748 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003749
3750 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003751 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003752 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003753 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003754 return true;
3755}
3756
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003757/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3758/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3759/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003760///
3761/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3762/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3763/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3764///
3765/// return (A +/- B).
3766///
3767Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003768 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003769 Instruction &I) {
3770 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3771 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3772 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3773
3774 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3775
3776 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3777 default: return 0;
3778 case Instruction::And:
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003779 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003780 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003781 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3782 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3783 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003784 break;
3785
3786 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3787 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3788 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003789 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003790 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003791 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003792 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003793 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003794 break;
3795 }
3796 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003797 return 0;
3798 case Instruction::Or:
3799 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003800 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003801 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3802 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003803 && ConstantExpr::getAnd(N, Mask)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003804 break;
3805 return 0;
3806 }
3807
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003808 if (isSub)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003809 return Builder->CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3810 return Builder->CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003811}
3812
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003813/// FoldAndOfICmps - Fold (icmp)&(icmp) if possible.
3814Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I,
3815 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003816 Value *Val, *Val2;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003817 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
3818 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3819
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003820 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 B, C2).
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00003821 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003822 m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00003823 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003824 m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003825 return 0;
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003826
3827 // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3828 // where C is a power of 2
3829 if (LHSCst == RHSCst && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3830 LHSCst->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003831 Value *NewOr = Builder->CreateOr(Val, Val2);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003832 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003833 }
3834
3835 // From here on, we only handle:
3836 // (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
3837 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
3838
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003839 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
3840 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3841 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3842 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
3843 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
3844 return 0;
3845
3846 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) & (sgt x, C2).
3847 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
3848 return 0;
3849
3850 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003851 bool ShouldSwap;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003852 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3853 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3854 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003855 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003856 else
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003857 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
3858
3859 if (ShouldSwap) {
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003860 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3861 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3862 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3863 }
3864
3865 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
3866 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3867 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
3868 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3869 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3870 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
3871 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3872
3873 switch (LHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003874 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003875 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
3876 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003877 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003878 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3879 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3880 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003881 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003882 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3883 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3884 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3885 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3886 }
3887 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3888 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003889 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003890 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003891 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003892 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Val, LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003893 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3894 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003895 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003896 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Val, LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003897 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3898 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3899 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3900 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3901 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3902 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003903 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003904 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003905 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(Val, AddCST, Val->getName()+".off");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003906 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003907 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003908 }
3909 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3910 }
3911 break;
3912 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3913 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003914 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003915 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3916 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003917 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003918 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3919 break;
3920 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3921 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
3922 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3923 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3924 break;
3925 }
3926 break;
3927 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3928 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003929 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003930 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3931 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003932 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003933 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3934 break;
3935 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3936 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
3937 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3938 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3939 break;
3940 }
3941 break;
3942 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3943 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003944 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003945 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3946 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3947 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3948 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3949 break;
3950 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003951 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003952 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003953 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003954 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) -> (X-14) <u 1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003955 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003956 RHSCst, false, true, I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003957 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3958 break;
3959 }
3960 break;
3961 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3962 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003963 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003964 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3965 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3966 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3967 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3968 break;
3969 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003970 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003971 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003972 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003973 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) -> (X-14) s< 1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003974 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003975 RHSCst, true, true, I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003976 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3977 break;
3978 }
3979 break;
3980 }
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003981
3982 return 0;
3983}
3984
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00003985Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS,
3986 FCmpInst *RHS) {
3987
3988 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
3989 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
3990 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
3991 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3992 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3993 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3994 // false.
3995 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003997 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00003998 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
3999 }
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00004000
4001 // Handle vector zeros. This occurs because the canonical form of
4002 // "fcmp ord x,x" is "fcmp ord x, 0".
4003 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(LHS->getOperand(1)) &&
4004 isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(RHS->getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004005 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00004006 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004007 return 0;
4008 }
4009
4010 Value *Op0LHS = LHS->getOperand(0), *Op0RHS = LHS->getOperand(1);
4011 Value *Op1LHS = RHS->getOperand(0), *Op1RHS = RHS->getOperand(1);
4012 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC = LHS->getPredicate(), Op1CC = RHS->getPredicate();
4013
4014
4015 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4016 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4017 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4018 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4019 }
4020
4021 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4022 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4023 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004024 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004025
4026 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE || Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004027 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004028 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4029 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4030 if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4031 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4032
4033 bool Op0Ordered;
4034 bool Op1Ordered;
4035 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4036 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4037 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
4038 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4039 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
4040 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
4041 }
4042 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4043 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4044 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4045 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4046 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4047
4048 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4049 // uno && ord -> false
4050 if (!Op0Ordered)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004051 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004052 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4053 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4054 Op0LHS, Op0RHS, Context));
4055 }
4056 }
4057
4058 return 0;
4059}
4060
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004061
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004062Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004063 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004064 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004065
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004066 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004067 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004068
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004069 // and X, X = X
4070 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004071 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004072
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004073 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00004074 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004075 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
4076 return &I;
4077 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00004078 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004079 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00004080 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004081 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4082 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00004083 }
4084 }
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004085
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004086 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner7acdf1d2009-10-11 22:00:32 +00004087 const APInt &AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004088 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004089
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004090 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Chris Lattner7acdf1d2009-10-11 22:00:32 +00004091 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004092 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
4093 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
4094 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner7acdf1d2009-10-11 22:00:32 +00004095 default: break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004096 case Instruction::Xor:
4097 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004098 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
Chris Lattner7acdf1d2009-10-11 22:00:32 +00004099 if (!Op0I->hasOneUse()) break;
4100
4101 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
4102 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
4103 Value *NewRHS = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
4104 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
4105 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0I->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
4106 }
4107 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
4108 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
4109 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
4110 Value *NewLHS = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
4111 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
4112 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0I->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004113 }
4114
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004115 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004116 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004117 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
4118 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4119 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4120 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004121 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004122 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004123 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004124 break;
4125
4126 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004127 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
4128 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4129 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4130 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004131 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004132
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00004133 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
4134 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
4135 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4136 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
4137 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
4138 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
4139
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004140 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00004141 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
4142 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004143 Value *NewNeg = Builder->CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004144 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
4145 }
4146 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004147 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00004148
4149 case Instruction::Shl:
4150 case Instruction::LShr:
4151 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
4152 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00004153 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004154 Value *NewICmp =
4155 Builder->CreateICmpEQ(Op0RHS, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00004156 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
4157 }
4158 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004159 }
4160
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00004161 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004162 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004163 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004164 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004165 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
4166 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
4167 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
4168 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004169 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004170 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004171 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004172 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
4173 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004174 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
4175 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
4176 // other simplifications.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004177 Value *NewCast = Builder->CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00004178 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
4179 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004180 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004181 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004182 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004183 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004184 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4185 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
4186 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004187 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004188 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004189 // trunc(C1)&C2
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004190 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
4191 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004192 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004193 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00004194 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004195
4196 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4197 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004198 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004199 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004200 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4201 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4202 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00004203 }
4204
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004205 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
4206 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004207
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004208 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004209 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004210
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004211 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004212 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004213 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
4214 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004215 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004216 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004217
4218 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004219 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004220 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004221 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
4222 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004223
4224 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004225 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004226 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004227 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004228 }
4229 }
4230
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004231 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004232 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
4233 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004234
4235 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004236 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004237 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004238 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004239 }
4240 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004241
4242 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004243 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004244 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
4245 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
4246 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4247 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
4248 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
4249 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
4250 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4251 }
4252 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00004253
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004254 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004255 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004256 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
4257 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
4258 std::swap(A, B);
4259 }
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004260 if (A == Op0) // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
4261 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Builder->CreateNot(B, "tmp"));
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004262 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00004263
4264 // (A&((~A)|B)) -> A&B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004265 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)), m_Value(A))) ||
4266 match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)))))
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00004267 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op1);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004268 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)), m_Value(A))) ||
4269 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)))))
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00004270 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004271 }
4272
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004273 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
4274 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004275 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004276 return R;
4277
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004278 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
4279 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4280 return Res;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00004281 }
4282
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004283 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004284 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
4285 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
4286 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
4287 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00004288 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() &&
4289 SrcTy->isIntOrIntVector() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004290 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004291 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4292 I.getType(), TD) &&
4293 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4294 I.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004295 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4296 Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004297 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004298 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004299 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004300
4301 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004302 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4303 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4304 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004305 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4306 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004307 Value *NewOp =
4308 Builder->CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0), SI1->getOperand(0),
4309 SI0->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004310 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004311 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004312 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004313 }
4314
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004315 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004316 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004317 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4318 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfFCmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4319 return Res;
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004320 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004321
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004322 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004323}
4324
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004325/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4326/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4327/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4328/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4329/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4330/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4331/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4332/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4333/// match.
4334///
4335/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4336/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4337/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4338/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4339/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4340/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4341///
4342/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4343/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4344/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4345/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4346/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4347///
4348static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4349 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4350 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4351 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4352 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4353 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4354 ByteValues) ||
4355 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4356 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004357 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004358
4359 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4360 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4361 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4362 unsigned ShAmt =
4363 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4364 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4365 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4366 return true;
4367
4368 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4369 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4370 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4371 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4372 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4373 } else {
4374 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4375 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4376 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004377 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004378 }
4379
4380 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4381 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4382
4383 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4384 ByteValues);
4385 }
4386
4387 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4388 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4389 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4390 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4391 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4392 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4393 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4394 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4395
4396 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4397 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4398 // the and mask is.
4399 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4400 continue;
4401
4402 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4403 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4404 if (MaskB == 0) {
4405 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4406 continue;
4407 }
4408
4409 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4410 if (MaskB != Byte)
4411 return true;
4412
4413 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4414 }
4415
4416 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4417 ByteValues);
4418 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004419 }
4420
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004421 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4422 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4423 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4424 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4425 // their ultimate destination.
4426 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4427 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004428
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004429 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4430 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4431 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4432 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4433 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4434 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4435 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4436 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4437 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4438 return true;
4439 } else {
4440 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4441 return true;
4442 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004443
4444 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4445 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004446 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004447 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004448 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004449 return false;
4450}
4451
4452/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4453/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4454Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004455 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004456 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4457 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4458 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004459 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004460
4461 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4462 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004463 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004464 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004465
4466 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004467 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4468 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004469 return 0;
4470
4471 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4472 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4473 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4474
4475 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4476 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4477 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4478 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004479 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004480 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004481 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004482 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004483}
4484
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004485/// MatchSelectFromAndOr - We have an expression of the form (A&C)|(B&D). Check
4486/// If A is (cond?-1:0) and either B or D is ~(cond?-1,0) or (cond?0,-1), then
4487/// we can simplify this expression to "cond ? C : D or B".
4488static Instruction *MatchSelectFromAndOr(Value *A, Value *B,
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004489 Value *C, Value *D,
4490 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004491 // If A is not a select of -1/0, this cannot match.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004492 Value *Cond = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004493 if (!match(A, m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Value(Cond))))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004494 return 0;
4495
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004496 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | (B&(cond?0:-1)) -> cond ? C : B.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004497 if (match(D, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004498 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004499 if (match(D, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond)))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004500 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
4501 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | ((cond?0:-1)&D) -> cond ? C : D.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004502 if (match(B, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004503 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004504 if (match(B, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond)))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004505 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004506 return 0;
4507}
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004508
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004509/// FoldOrOfICmps - Fold (icmp)|(icmp) if possible.
4510Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I,
4511 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
4512 Value *Val, *Val2;
4513 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
4514 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4515
4516 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 B, C2).
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004517 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004518 m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004519 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004520 m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004521 return 0;
4522
4523 // From here on, we only handle:
4524 // (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
4525 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
4526
4527 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
4528 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4529 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4530 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
4531 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
4532 return 0;
4533
4534 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4535 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
4536 return 0;
4537
4538 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
4539 bool ShouldSwap;
4540 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
4541 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
4542 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
4543 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
4544 else
4545 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
4546
4547 if (ShouldSwap) {
4548 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4549 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4550 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4551 }
4552
4553 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
4554 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4555 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
4556 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4557 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
4558 // equal.
4559 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4560
4561 switch (LHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004562 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004563 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4564 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004565 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004566 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004567 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004568 // (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004569 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004570 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(Val, AddCST, Val->getName()+".off");
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004571 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getSub(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004572 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004573 }
4574 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4575 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4576 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
4577 break;
4578 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4579 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4580 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4581 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4582 }
4583 break;
4584 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4585 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004586 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004587 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4588 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4589 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
4590 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4591 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4592 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4593 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004594 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004595 }
4596 break;
4597 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4598 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004599 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004600 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4601 break;
4602 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) -> (X-13) u> 2
4603 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4604 // this can cause overflow.
4605 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4606 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004607 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004608 false, false, I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004609 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4610 break;
4611 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4612 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4613 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4614 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4615 break;
4616 }
4617 break;
4618 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4619 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004620 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004621 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4622 break;
4623 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) -> (X-13) s> 2
4624 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4625 // this can cause overflow.
4626 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4627 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004628 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004629 true, false, I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004630 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4631 break;
4632 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4633 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4634 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4635 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4636 break;
4637 }
4638 break;
4639 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4640 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004641 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004642 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4643 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4644 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4645 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4646 break;
4647 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4648 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004649 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004650 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4651 break;
4652 }
4653 break;
4654 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4655 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004656 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004657 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4658 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4659 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4660 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4661 break;
4662 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4663 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004664 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004665 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4666 break;
4667 }
4668 break;
4669 }
4670 return 0;
4671}
4672
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004673Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS,
4674 FCmpInst *RHS) {
4675 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4676 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4677 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
4678 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4679 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4680 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4681 // true.
4682 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004683 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004684
4685 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4686 // rest.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004687 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004688 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
4689 }
4690
4691 // Handle vector zeros. This occurs because the canonical form of
4692 // "fcmp uno x,x" is "fcmp uno x, 0".
4693 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(LHS->getOperand(1)) &&
4694 isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(RHS->getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004695 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004696 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
4697
4698 return 0;
4699 }
4700
4701 Value *Op0LHS = LHS->getOperand(0), *Op0RHS = LHS->getOperand(1);
4702 Value *Op1LHS = RHS->getOperand(0), *Op1RHS = RHS->getOperand(1);
4703 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC = LHS->getPredicate(), Op1CC = RHS->getPredicate();
4704
4705 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4706 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4707 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4708 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4709 }
4710 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4711 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4712 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004713 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC,
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004714 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4715 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE || Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004716 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004717 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4718 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4719 if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4720 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4721 bool Op0Ordered;
4722 bool Op1Ordered;
4723 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4724 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4725 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4726 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4727 // or'ed predicates.
4728 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
4729 Op0LHS, Op0RHS, Context);
4730 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4731 return I;
4732 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4733 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4734 }
4735 }
4736 return 0;
4737}
4738
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004739/// FoldOrWithConstants - This helper function folds:
4740///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004741/// ((A | B) & C1) | (B & C2)
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004742///
4743/// into:
4744///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004745/// (A & C1) | B
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004746///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004747/// when the XOR of the two constants is "all ones" (-1).
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004748Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004749 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C) {
Bill Wendlingdda74e02008-12-02 05:06:43 +00004750 ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4751 if (!CI1) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004752
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00004753 Value *V1 = 0;
4754 ConstantInt *CI2 = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004755 if (!match(Op, m_And(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CI2)))) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004756
Bill Wendling29976b92008-12-02 06:18:11 +00004757 APInt Xor = CI1->getValue() ^ CI2->getValue();
4758 if (!Xor.isAllOnesValue()) return 0;
4759
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00004760 if (V1 == A || V1 == B) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004761 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateAnd((V1 == A) ? B : A, CI1);
Bill Wendlingd16c6e92008-12-02 06:22:04 +00004762 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NewOp, V1);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004763 }
4764
4765 return 0;
4766}
4767
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004768Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004769 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004770 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004771
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004772 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004773 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004774
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004775 // or X, X = X
4776 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004777 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004778
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004779 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4780 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004781 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
4782 return &I;
4783 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4784 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4785 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4786 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4787 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4788 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
4789 }
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004790 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004791
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004792 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004793 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004794 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004795 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004796 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004797 isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004798 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004799 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004800 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00004801 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004802 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004803
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004804 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004805 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004806 isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004807 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004808 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004809 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00004810 ConstantInt::get(*Context, C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004811 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004812
4813 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4814 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004815 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004816 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004817 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4818 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4819 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004820 }
4821
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004822 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4823 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004824
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004825 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004826 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4827 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004828 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004829 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4830 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4831
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004832 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4833 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004834 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4835 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4836 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4837 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004838 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4839 return BSwap;
4840 }
4841
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004842 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004843 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004844 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004845 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004846 Value *NOr = Builder->CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004847 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004848 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004849 }
4850
4851 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004852 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004853 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004854 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004855 Value *NOr = Builder->CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004856 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004857 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004858 }
4859
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004860 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004861 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004862 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4863 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004864 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4865 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4866 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4867 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4868 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4869 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4870 // replace with V+N.
4871 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4872 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004873 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004874 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4875 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4876 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4877 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4878 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4879 }
4880 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4881 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004882 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004883 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4884 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4885 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4886 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4887 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4888 }
4889 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004890 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004891 }
4892
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004893 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4894 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004895 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4896 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4897 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4898 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4899 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4900 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4901 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4902 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4903 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4904
4905 if (V1) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004906 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004907 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004908 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004909 }
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004910
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004911 // (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004912 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(A, B, C, D, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004913 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004914 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(B, A, D, C, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004915 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004916 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(C, B, A, D, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004917 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004918 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(D, A, B, C, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004919 return Match;
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004920
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004921 // ((A&~B)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004922 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(D))) &&
4923 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(A)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004924 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004925 // ((~B&A)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004926 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(D))) &&
4927 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(C)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004928 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004929 // ((A&~B)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004930 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(B))) &&
4931 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(A)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004932 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004933 // ((~B&A)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004934 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(B))) &&
4935 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(C)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004936 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, B);
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004937 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004938
4939 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004940 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4941 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4942 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004943 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4944 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004945 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0), SI1->getOperand(0),
4946 SI0->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004947 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004948 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004949 }
4950 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004951
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004952 // ((A|B)&1)|(B&-2) -> (A&1) | B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004953 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C))) ||
4954 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004955 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op1, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004956 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004957 }
4958 // (B&-2)|((A|B)&1) -> (A&1) | B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004959 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C))) ||
4960 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004961 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op0, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004962 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004963 }
4964
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004965 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004966 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004967 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004968 } else {
4969 A = 0;
4970 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004971 // Note, A is still live here!
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004972 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004973 if (Op0 == B)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004974 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004975
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004976 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004977 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004978 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(A, B, I.getName()+".demorgan");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004979 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004980 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004981 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004982
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004983 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4984 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004985 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004986 return R;
4987
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004988 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
4989 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4990 return Res;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004991 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004992
4993 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004994 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004995 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004996 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004997 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4998 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4999 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00005000 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() &&
5001 SrcTy->isIntOrIntVector() &&
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00005002 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
5003 // generated.
5004 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
5005 I.getType(), TD) &&
5006 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
5007 I.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005008 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
5009 Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005010 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00005011 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005012 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005013 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005014 }
5015
5016
5017 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
5018 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00005019 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
5020 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfFCmps(I, LHS, RHS))
5021 return Res;
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005022 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00005023
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005024 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005025}
5026
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00005027namespace {
5028
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005029// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
5030struct XorSelf {
5031 Value *RHS;
5032 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
5033 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
5034 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
5035 return &Xor;
5036 }
5037};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005038
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00005039}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005040
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005041Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00005042 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005043 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005044
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00005045 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
5046 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
5047 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
5048 // idiom (misuse).
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005049 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005050 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00005051 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005052
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005053 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005054 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00005055 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005056 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005057 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005058
5059 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5060 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005061 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
5062 return &I;
5063 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType()))
5064 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
5065 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005066
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005067 // Is this a ~ operation?
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005068 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005069 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5070 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5071 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
5072 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
5073 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005074 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
5075 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005076 Value *NotY =
5077 Builder->CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
5078 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005079 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005080 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005081 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005082 }
5083 }
5084 }
5085 }
5086
5087
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005088 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner7acdf1d2009-10-11 22:00:32 +00005089 if (RHS->isOne() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Bill Wendling3479be92009-01-01 01:18:23 +00005090 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005091 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005092 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005093 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00005094
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005095 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005096 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005097 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
5098 }
5099
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005100 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
5101 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
5102 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
5103 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
5104 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005105 if ((Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) &&
5106 (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode,
5107 ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
5108 Op0C->getDestTy()))) {
5109 CI->setPredicate(CI->getInversePredicate());
5110 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, CI, Op0C->getType());
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005111 }
5112 }
5113 }
5114 }
5115
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005116 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00005117 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005118 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
5119 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005120 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
5121 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005122 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005123 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005124 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00005125
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005126 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005127 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00005128 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005129 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005130 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005131 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005132 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005133 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005134 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00005135 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00005136 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005137 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(*Context,
5138 RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005139 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00005140
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005141 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005142 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
5143 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00005144 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005145 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005146 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
5147 // NewRHS.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005148 Constant *CommonBits = ConstantExpr::getAnd(Op0CI, RHS);
5149 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
5150 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00005151 Worklist.Add(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005152 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
5153 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
5154 return &I;
5155 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00005156 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005157 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00005158 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005159
5160 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5161 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005162 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005163 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00005164 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5165 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5166 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005167 }
5168
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005169 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005170 if (X == Op1)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005171 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005172
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005173 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005174 if (X == Op0)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005175 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005176
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005177
5178 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
5179 if (Op1I) {
5180 Value *A, *B;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005181 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005182 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005183 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005184 I.swapOperands();
5185 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005186 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005187 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005188 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005189 }
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005190 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005191 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // A^(A^B) == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005192 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op0)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005193 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // A^(B^A) == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005194 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005195 Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00005196 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005197 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00005198 std::swap(A, B);
5199 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005200 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005201 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
5202 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
5203 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00005204 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005205 }
5206
5207 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
5208 if (Op0I) {
5209 Value *A, *B;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005210 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005211 Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005212 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
5213 std::swap(A, B);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005214 if (B == Op1) // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
5215 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Builder->CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"));
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005216 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005217 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // (A^B)^A == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005218 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op1)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005219 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // (B^A)^A == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005220 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005221 Op0I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005222 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
5223 std::swap(A, B);
5224 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00005225 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005226 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Builder->CreateNot(A, "tmp"), Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005227 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005228 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005229 }
5230
5231 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
5232 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
5233 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
5234 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5235 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005236 Value *NewOp =
5237 Builder->CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op1I->getOperand(0),
5238 Op0I->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005239 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005240 Op1I->getOperand(1));
5241 }
5242
5243 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
5244 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5245 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005246 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5247 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005248 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005249 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005250 }
5251 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005252 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5253 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005254 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005255 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005256 }
5257
5258 // (A & B)^(C & D)
5259 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005260 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5261 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005262 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
5263 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5264 if (A == C)
5265 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
5266 else if (A == D)
5267 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
5268 else if (B == C)
5269 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
5270 else if (B == D)
5271 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
5272
5273 if (X) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005274 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005275 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005276 }
5277 }
5278 }
5279
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005280 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
5281 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005282 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00005283 return R;
5284
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005285 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005286 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005287 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005288 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
5289 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00005290 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005291 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005292 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
5293 I.getType(), TD) &&
5294 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
5295 I.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005296 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
5297 Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005298 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005299 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005300 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005301 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005302
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005303 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005304}
5305
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005306static ConstantInt *ExtractElement(Constant *V, Constant *Idx,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005307 LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005308 return cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getExtractElement(V, Idx));
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005309}
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005310
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005311static bool HasAddOverflow(ConstantInt *Result,
5312 ConstantInt *In1, ConstantInt *In2,
5313 bool IsSigned) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00005314 if (IsSigned)
5315 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5316 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5317 else
5318 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5319 else
5320 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005321}
5322
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005323/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005324/// overflowed for this type.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005325static bool AddWithOverflow(Constant *&Result, Constant *In1,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005326 Constant *In2, LLVMContext *Context,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005327 bool IsSigned = false) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005328 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(In1, In2);
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005329
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005330 if (const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(In1->getType())) {
5331 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005332 Constant *Idx = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005333 if (HasAddOverflow(ExtractElement(Result, Idx, Context),
5334 ExtractElement(In1, Idx, Context),
5335 ExtractElement(In2, Idx, Context),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005336 IsSigned))
5337 return true;
5338 }
5339 return false;
5340 }
5341
5342 return HasAddOverflow(cast<ConstantInt>(Result),
5343 cast<ConstantInt>(In1), cast<ConstantInt>(In2),
5344 IsSigned);
5345}
5346
5347static bool HasSubOverflow(ConstantInt *Result,
5348 ConstantInt *In1, ConstantInt *In2,
5349 bool IsSigned) {
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005350 if (IsSigned)
5351 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5352 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5353 else
5354 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5355 else
5356 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
5357}
5358
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005359/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
5360/// overflowed for this type.
5361static bool SubWithOverflow(Constant *&Result, Constant *In1,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005362 Constant *In2, LLVMContext *Context,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005363 bool IsSigned = false) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005364 Result = ConstantExpr::getSub(In1, In2);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005365
5366 if (const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(In1->getType())) {
5367 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005368 Constant *Idx = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005369 if (HasSubOverflow(ExtractElement(Result, Idx, Context),
5370 ExtractElement(In1, Idx, Context),
5371 ExtractElement(In2, Idx, Context),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005372 IsSigned))
5373 return true;
5374 }
5375 return false;
5376 }
5377
5378 return HasSubOverflow(cast<ConstantInt>(Result),
5379 cast<ConstantInt>(In1), cast<ConstantInt>(In2),
5380 IsSigned);
5381}
5382
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005383/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
5384/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
5385/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
5386static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005387 TargetData &TD = *IC.getTargetData();
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005388 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005389 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType(I.getContext());
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005390 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005391
5392 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005393 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005394 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005395
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00005396 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
5397 ++i, ++GTI) {
5398 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005399 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005400 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
5401 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
5402
5403 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5404 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5405 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
5406
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005407 Result = IC.Builder->CreateAdd(Result,
5408 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
5409 GEP->getName()+".offs");
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005410 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005411 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005412
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005413 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005414 Constant *OC =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005415 ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
5416 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005417 // Emit an add instruction.
5418 Result = IC.Builder->CreateAdd(Result, Scale, GEP->getName()+".offs");
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005419 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005420 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005421 // Convert to correct type.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005422 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy)
5423 Op = IC.Builder->CreateIntCast(Op, IntPtrTy, true, Op->getName()+".c");
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005424 if (Size != 1) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005425 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005426 // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
5427 Op = IC.Builder->CreateMul(Op, Scale, GEP->getName()+".idx");
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005428 }
5429
5430 // Emit an add instruction.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005431 Result = IC.Builder->CreateAdd(Op, Result, GEP->getName()+".offs");
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005432 }
5433 return Result;
5434}
5435
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005436
Dan Gohman8f080f02009-07-17 22:16:21 +00005437/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return a value that can be used to compare
5438/// the *offset* implied by a GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we
5439/// want to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can
5440/// be complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be
5441/// legal to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32).
5442/// This later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed
5443/// to generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005444///
5445/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5446///
5447static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5448 InstCombiner &IC) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005449 TargetData &TD = *IC.getTargetData();
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005450 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5451
5452 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5453 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5454 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5455 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5456 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5457 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5458 int64_t Offset = 0;
5459 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5460 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5461 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5462 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5463
5464 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5465 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5466 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5467 } else {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005468 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005469 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5470 }
5471 } else {
5472 // Found our variable index.
5473 break;
5474 }
5475 }
5476
5477 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5478 // evaluate it the general way.
5479 if (i == e) return 0;
5480
5481 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5482 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5483 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005484 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005485
5486 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5487 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5488 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5489 if (!CI) return 0;
5490
5491 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5492 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5493
5494 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5495 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5496 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5497 } else {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005498 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005499 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5500 }
5501 }
5502
5503 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5504 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5505 // the index.
5506 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5507 if (Offset == 0) {
5508 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5509 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5510 // computation crosses zero.
5511 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005512 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx,
5513 TD.getIntPtrType(VariableIdx->getContext()),
Daniel Dunbar460f6562009-07-26 09:48:23 +00005514 VariableIdx->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005515 return VariableIdx;
5516 }
5517
5518 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5519 // the pointer size, so get it.
5520 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5521
5522 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5523 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5524
5525 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5526 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5527 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5528 // multiple of the variable scale.
5529 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5530 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5531 return 0;
5532
5533 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005534 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType(VariableIdx->getContext());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005535 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005536 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005537 true /*SExt*/,
Daniel Dunbar460f6562009-07-26 09:48:23 +00005538 VariableIdx->getName(), &I);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005539 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005540 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005541}
5542
5543
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005544/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005545/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005546Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(GEPOperator *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005547 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5548 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005549 // Look through bitcasts.
5550 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5551 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005552
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005553 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005554 if (TD && PtrBase == RHS && GEPLHS->isInBounds()) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005555 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005556 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005557 // know pointers can't overflow since the gep is inbounds. See if we can
5558 // output an optimized form.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005559 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5560
5561 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5562 if (Offset == 0)
5563 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005564 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005565 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005566 } else if (GEPOperator *GEPRHS = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005567 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5568 // compare the base pointer.
5569 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5570 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005571 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005572 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005573 if (IndicesTheSame)
5574 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5575 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5576 IndicesTheSame = false;
5577 break;
5578 }
5579
5580 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5581 if (IndicesTheSame)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005582 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005583 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005584
5585 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5586 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005587 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005588 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005589
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005590 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5591 bool AllZeros = true;
5592 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5593 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5594 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5595 AllZeros = false;
5596 break;
5597 }
5598 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005599 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5600 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005601
5602 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005603 AllZeros = true;
5604 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5605 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5606 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5607 AllZeros = false;
5608 break;
5609 }
5610 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005611 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005612
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005613 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5614 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5615 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5616 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5617 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5618 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005619 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5620 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005621 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005622 NumDifferences = 2;
5623 break;
5624 } else {
5625 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5626 DiffOperand = i;
5627 }
5628 }
5629
5630 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5631 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005632 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005633 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005634
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005635 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005636 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5637 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005638 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005639 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005640 }
5641 }
5642
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005643 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005644 // the result to fold to a constant!
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005645 if (TD &&
5646 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005647 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5648 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5649 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5650 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005651 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005652 }
5653 }
5654 return 0;
5655}
5656
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005657/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5658///
5659Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5660 Instruction *LHSI,
5661 Constant *RHSC) {
5662 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5663 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5664
5665 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5666 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005667 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005668 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5669
5670 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5671 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5672 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005673 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005674
5675 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005676 bool LHSUnsigned = isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI);
5677 if (LHSUnsigned)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005678 ++InputSize;
5679
5680 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5681 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5682 return 0;
5683
5684 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5685 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5686 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5687 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5688
5689 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5690 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005691 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected predicate!");
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005692 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005693 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ:
5694 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ;
5695 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005696 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005697 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
5698 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5699 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005700 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005701 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
5702 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5703 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005704 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005705 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
5706 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5707 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005708 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005709 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
5710 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5711 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005712 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005713 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE:
5714 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5715 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005716 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005717 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005718 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005719 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005720 }
5721
5722 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5723
5724 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5725
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005726 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005727 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005728 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005729
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005730 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5731 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5732 // and large values.
5733 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5734 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5735 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5736 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
5737 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5738 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005739 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
5740 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005741 }
5742 } else {
5743 // If the RHS value is > UnsignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles
5744 // +INF and large values.
5745 APFloat UMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5746 UMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getMaxValue(IntWidth), false,
5747 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5748 if (UMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // umax < 13123.0
5749 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5750 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
5752 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005753 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005754 }
5755
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005756 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5757 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5758 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5759 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5760 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5761 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
5762 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5763 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005764 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
5765 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005766 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005767 }
5768
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005769 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] or
5770 // [0, UMAX], but it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by
5771 // casting the FP value to the integer value and back, checking for equality.
5772 // Don't do this for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005773 Constant *RHSInt = LHSUnsigned
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005774 ? ConstantExpr::getFPToUI(RHSC, IntTy)
5775 : ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005776 if (!RHS.isZero()) {
5777 bool Equal = LHSUnsigned
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005778 ? ConstantExpr::getUIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) == RHSC
5779 : ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) == RHSC;
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005780 if (!Equal) {
5781 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
5782 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
5783 // zero at this point.
5784 switch (Pred) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005785 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer comparison!");
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005786 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005787 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005788 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005789 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005790 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5791 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5792 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> false
5793 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005794 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005795 break;
5796 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5797 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5798 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5799 if (RHS.isNegative())
5800 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5801 break;
5802 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5803 // (float)int < -4.4 --> false
5804 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5805 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005806 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005807 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
5808 break;
5809 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5810 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5811 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5812 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5813 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5814 break;
5815 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5816 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5817 // (float)int > -4.4 --> true
5818 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005819 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005820 break;
5821 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5822 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5823 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5824 if (RHS.isNegative())
5825 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5826 break;
5827 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5828 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> true
5829 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5830 if (!RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005831 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005832 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
5833 break;
5834 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5835 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5836 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5837 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5838 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5839 break;
5840 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005841 }
5842 }
5843
5844 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5845 // comparison.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005846 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005847}
5848
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005849Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5850 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005851 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005852
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005853 // Fold trivial predicates.
5854 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005855 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 0));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005856 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005857 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005858
5859 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5860 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5861 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005862 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown predicate!");
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005863 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5864 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5865 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005866 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005867 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5868 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5869 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005870 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 0));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005871
5872 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5873 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5874 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5875 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5876 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5877 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005878 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005879 return &I;
5880
5881 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5882 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5883 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5884 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5885 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5886 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005887 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005888 return &I;
5889 }
5890 }
5891
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005892 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005893 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005894
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005895 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5896 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005897 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5898 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5899 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5900 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005901 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005902 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5903 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5904 // True if unordered.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005905 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005906 }
5907 }
5908
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005909 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5910 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5911 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005912 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5913 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5914 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5915 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00005916 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I, true))
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005917 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005918 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005919 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5920 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5921 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5922 return NV;
5923 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005924 case Instruction::Select:
5925 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5926 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5927 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5928 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5929 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5930 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5931 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005932 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005933 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005934 Op2 = Builder->CreateFCmp(I.getPredicate(),
5935 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC, I.getName());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005936 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5937 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005938 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005939 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005940 Op1 = Builder->CreateFCmp(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(1),
5941 RHSC, I.getName());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005942 }
5943 }
5944
5945 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005946 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005947 break;
5948 }
5949 }
5950
5951 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5952}
5953
5954Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5955 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5956 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5957 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5958
5959 // icmp X, X
5960 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005961 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(),
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005962 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005963
5964 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005965 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005966
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005967 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005968 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Chris Lattnerbbc33852009-10-05 02:47:47 +00005969 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005970 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
Chris Lattnerbbc33852009-10-05 02:47:47 +00005971 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005972 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005973 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005974 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005975
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005976 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005977 if (Ty == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005978 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005979 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005980 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005981 Value *Xor = Builder->CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005982 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005983 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005984 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005985 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005986
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005987 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005988 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005989 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005990 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005991 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005992 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005993 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005994 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5995 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005996 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005997 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005998 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005999 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
6000 }
6001 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6002 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
6003 // FALL THROUGH
6004 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006005 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006006 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006007 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006008 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6009 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
6010 // FALL THROUGH
6011 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006012 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006013 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
6014 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006015 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006016 }
6017
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006018 unsigned BitWidth = 0;
6019 if (TD)
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00006020 BitWidth = TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty->getScalarType());
6021 else if (Ty->isIntOrIntVector())
6022 BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006023
6024 bool isSignBit = false;
6025
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006026 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006027 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky579214a2009-02-27 06:37:39 +00006028 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00006029
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00006030 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
6031 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006032 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00006033 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006034 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00006035 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00006036
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006037 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
6038 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
6039 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006040 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
6041 default: break;
6042 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
6043 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006044 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006045 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006046 AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006047 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
6048 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006049 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006050 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006051 AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006052 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6053 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006054 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006055 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006056 SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006057 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6058 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006059 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006060 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006061 SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006062 }
6063
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006064 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006065 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006066 bool UnusedBit;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006067 isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
6068 }
6069
6070 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
6071 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
6072 if (BitWidth != 0) {
6073 APInt Op0KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), Op0KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6074 APInt Op1KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), Op1KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6075
6076 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I.getOperandUse(0),
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006077 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
6078 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006079 Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne, 0))
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006080 return &I;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006081 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I.getOperandUse(1),
6082 APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
6083 Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne, 0))
6084 return &I;
6085
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006086 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006087 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
6088 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006089 APInt Op0Min(BitWidth, 0), Op0Max(BitWidth, 0);
6090 APInt Op1Min(BitWidth, 0), Op1Max(BitWidth, 0);
6091 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
6092 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne,
6093 Op0Min, Op0Max);
6094 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne,
6095 Op1Min, Op1Max);
6096 } else {
6097 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne,
6098 Op0Min, Op0Max);
6099 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne,
6100 Op1Min, Op1Max);
6101 }
6102
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006103 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
6104 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
6105 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006106 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0) && Op0Min == Op0Max)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006107 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006108 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Op0Min), Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006109 if (!isa<Constant>(Op1) && Op1Min == Op1Max)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006110 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006111 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Op1Min));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006112
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006113 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
6114 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006115 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006116 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown icmp opcode!");
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006117 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006118 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min) || Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max))
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006119 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006120 break;
6121 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006122 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min) || Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max))
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006123 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006124 break;
6125 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006126 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min)) // A <u B -> true if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006127 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006128 if (Op0Min.uge(Op1Max)) // A <u B -> false if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006129 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006130 if (Op1Min == Op0Max) // A <u B -> A != B if max(A) == min(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006131 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006132 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6133 if (Op1Max == Op0Min+1) // A <u C -> A == C-1 if min(A)+1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006134 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006135 SubOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006136
6137 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
6138 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006139 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006140 Constant::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006141 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006142 break;
6143 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006144 if (Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max)) // A >u B -> true if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006145 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006146 if (Op0Max.ule(Op1Min)) // A >u B -> false if max(A) <= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006147 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006148
6149 if (Op1Max == Op0Min) // A >u B -> A != B if min(A) == max(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006150 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006151 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6152 if (Op1Min == Op0Max-1) // A >u C -> A == C+1 if max(a)-1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006153 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006154 AddOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006155
6156 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
6157 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006158 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006159 Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006160 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006161 break;
6162 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006163 if (Op0Max.slt(Op1Min)) // A <s B -> true if max(A) < min(C)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006164 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006165 if (Op0Min.sge(Op1Max)) // A <s B -> false if min(A) >= max(C)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006166 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006167 if (Op1Min == Op0Max) // A <s B -> A != B if max(A) == min(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006168 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006169 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6170 if (Op1Max == Op0Min+1) // A <s C -> A == C-1 if min(A)+1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006171 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006172 SubOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006173 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006174 break;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006175 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
6176 if (Op0Min.sgt(Op1Max)) // A >s B -> true if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006177 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006178 if (Op0Max.sle(Op1Min)) // A >s B -> false if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006179 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006180
6181 if (Op1Max == Op0Min) // A >s B -> A != B if min(A) == max(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006182 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006183 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6184 if (Op1Min == Op0Max-1) // A >s C -> A == C+1 if max(A)-1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006185 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006186 AddOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006187 }
6188 break;
6189 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6190 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_SGE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6191 if (Op0Min.sge(Op1Max)) // A >=s B -> true if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006192 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006193 if (Op0Max.slt(Op1Min)) // A >=s B -> false if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006194 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006195 break;
6196 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
6197 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_SLE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6198 if (Op0Max.sle(Op1Min)) // A <=s B -> true if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006199 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006200 if (Op0Min.sgt(Op1Max)) // A <=s B -> false if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006201 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006202 break;
6203 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6204 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_UGE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6205 if (Op0Min.uge(Op1Max)) // A >=u B -> true if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006206 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006207 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min)) // A >=u B -> false if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006208 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006209 break;
6210 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
6211 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_ULE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6212 if (Op0Max.ule(Op1Min)) // A <=u B -> true if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006214 if (Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max)) // A <=u B -> false if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006215 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006216 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006217 }
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006218
6219 // Turn a signed comparison into an unsigned one if both operands
6220 // are known to have the same sign.
6221 if (I.isSignedPredicate() &&
6222 ((Op0KnownZero.isNegative() && Op1KnownZero.isNegative()) ||
6223 (Op0KnownOne.isNegative() && Op1KnownOne.isNegative())))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006224 return new ICmpInst(I.getUnsignedPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006225 }
6226
6227 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
6228 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
6229 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
6230 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
6231 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
6232 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
6233 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
6234 if (I.hasOneUse())
6235 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
6236 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
6237 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
6238 return 0;
6239
6240 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
6241 // can be folded into the comparison.
6242 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006243 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00006244 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006245 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00006246 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006247 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
6248 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006249 }
6250
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006251 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006252 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
6253 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
6254 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006255 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
6256 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006257 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006258 bool isAllZeros = true;
6259 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
6260 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
6261 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
6262 isAllZeros = false;
6263 break;
6264 }
6265 if (isAllZeros)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006266 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006267 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006268 }
6269 break;
6270
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006271 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00006272 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and icmp are in the same
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00006273 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
6274 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
6275 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00006276 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I, true))
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00006277 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006278 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006279 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006280 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
6281 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
6282 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
6283 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
6284 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6285 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6286 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006287 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006288 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006289 Op2 = Builder->CreateICmp(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(2),
6290 RHSC, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006291 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
6292 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006293 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006294 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006295 Op1 = Builder->CreateICmp(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(1),
6296 RHSC, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006297 }
6298 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00006299
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006300 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00006301 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006302 break;
6303 }
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00006304 case Instruction::Call:
6305 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
6306 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
6307 if (isMalloc(LHSI) && LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6308 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
Victor Hernandez68afa542009-10-21 19:11:40 +00006309 // Need to explicitly erase malloc call here, instead of adding it to
6310 // Worklist, because it won't get DCE'd from the Worklist since
6311 // isInstructionTriviallyDead() returns false for function calls.
6312 // It is OK to replace LHSI/MallocCall with Undef because the
6313 // instruction that uses it will be erased via Worklist.
6314 if (extractMallocCall(LHSI)) {
6315 LHSI->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(LHSI->getType()));
6316 EraseInstFromFunction(*LHSI);
6317 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00006318 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
6319 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Victor Hernandez68afa542009-10-21 19:11:40 +00006320 }
6321 if (CallInst* MallocCall = extractMallocCallFromBitCast(LHSI))
6322 if (MallocCall->hasOneUse()) {
6323 MallocCall->replaceAllUsesWith(
6324 UndefValue::get(MallocCall->getType()));
6325 EraseInstFromFunction(*MallocCall);
6326 Worklist.Add(LHSI); // The malloc's bitcast use.
6327 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
6328 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
6329 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
6330 }
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00006331 }
6332 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006333 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006334 }
6335
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006336 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00006337 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006338 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006339 return NI;
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00006340 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006341 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
6342 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006343 return NI;
6344
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006345 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006346 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
6347 // now.
6348 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
6349 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
6350 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006351 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
6352 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006353 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006354
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006355 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
6356 // so eliminate it as well.
6357 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
6358 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006359
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006360 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006361 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006362 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006363 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006364 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006365 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00006366 Op1 = Builder->CreateBitCast(Op1, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006367 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006368 }
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006369 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006370 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006371 }
6372
6373 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006374 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006375 // This comes up when you have code like
6376 // int X = A < B;
6377 // if (X) ...
6378 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006379 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
6380 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006381 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006382 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006383 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006384
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006385 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
6386 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6387 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006388 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006389 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1)) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00006390 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006391 default: break;
6392 case Instruction::Add:
6393 case Instruction::Sub:
6394 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006395 if (I.isEquality()) // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006396 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006397 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006398 // icmp u/s (a ^ signbit), (b ^ signbit) --> icmp s/u a, b
6399 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6400 if (CI->getValue().isSignBit()) {
6401 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = I.isSignedPredicate()
6402 ? I.getUnsignedPredicate()
6403 : I.getSignedPredicate();
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006404 return new ICmpInst(Pred, Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006405 Op1I->getOperand(0));
6406 }
6407
6408 if (CI->getValue().isMaxSignedValue()) {
6409 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = I.isSignedPredicate()
6410 ? I.getUnsignedPredicate()
6411 : I.getSignedPredicate();
6412 Pred = I.getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006413 return new ICmpInst(Pred, Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006414 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006415 }
6416 }
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006417 break;
6418 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006419 if (!I.isEquality())
6420 break;
6421
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006422 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6423 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
6424 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
6425 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
6426 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006427 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(*Context,
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006428 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
6429 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006430 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006431 Value *And1 = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0), Mask);
6432 Value *And2 = Builder->CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0), Mask);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006433 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006434 }
6435 }
6436 break;
6437 }
6438 }
6439 }
6440 }
6441
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006442 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
6443 { Value *A, *B;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006444 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
6445 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006446 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006447 }
6448
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00006449 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006450 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006451
6452 // -x == -y --> x == y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006453 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
6454 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006455 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006456
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006457 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006458 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
6459 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006460 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006461 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006462 }
6463
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006464 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006465 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006466 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006467 if (match(B, m_ConstantInt(C1)) &&
6468 match(D, m_ConstantInt(C2)) && Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006469 Constant *NC =
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006470 ConstantInt::get(*Context, C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006471 Value *Xor = Builder->CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
6472 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, Xor);
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006473 }
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006474
6475 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006476 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
6477 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
6478 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
6479 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006480 }
6481 }
6482
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006483 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006484 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006485 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
6486 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006487 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006488 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006489 }
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006490
6491 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006492 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006493 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006494 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006495
6496 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006497 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006498 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006499 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006500
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006501 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
6502 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006503 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6504 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006505 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
6506
6507 if (A == C) {
6508 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
6509 } else if (A == D) {
6510 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
6511 } else if (B == C) {
6512 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
6513 } else if (B == D) {
6514 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
6515 }
6516
6517 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006518 Op1 = Builder->CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp");
6519 Op1 = Builder->CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006520 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006521 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006522 return &I;
6523 }
6524 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006525 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006526 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006527}
6528
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006529
6530/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
6531/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
6532Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
6533 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
6534 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6535 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
6536
6537 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
6538 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
6539 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
6540 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
6541 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
6542 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
6543 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
6544 // if it finds it.
6545 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
6546 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
6547 return 0;
6548 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006549 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006550 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
6551 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
6552 if (DivRHS->isOne())
6553 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
6554 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006555
6556 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
6557 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
6558 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
6559 // instead of computing a divide.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006560 Constant *Prod = ConstantExpr::getMul(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006561
6562 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
6563 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6564 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006565 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6566 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006567
6568 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006569 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006570
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006571 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
6572 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
6573 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
6574 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
6575 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
6576 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
6577 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
6578 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00006579 Constant *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006580
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006581 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006582 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006583 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006584 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6585 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006586 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, Context, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006587 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006588 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006589 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006590 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006591 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006592 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006593 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6594 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6595 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006596 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, Context, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006597 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006598 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006599 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006600 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6601 if (!LoOverflow) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006602 ConstantInt* DivNeg =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006603 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006604 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg, Context,
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006605 true) ? -1 : 0;
6606 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006607 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006608 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006609 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006610 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006611 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006612 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006613 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6614 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6615 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6616 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006617 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006618 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006619 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006620 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006621 if (!LoOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006622 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound,
6623 DivRHS, Context, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006624 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006625 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6626 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006627 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006628 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, Context, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006629 }
6630
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006631 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6632 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006633 }
6634
6635 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006636 switch (Pred) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006637 default: llvm_unreachable("Unhandled icmp opcode!");
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006638 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6639 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006640 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006641 else if (HiOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006642 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006643 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6644 else if (LoOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006645 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006646 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6647 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006648 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006649 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6650 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006651 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006652 else if (HiOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006653 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006654 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6655 else if (LoOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006656 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006657 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6658 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006659 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006660 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6661 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006662 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006663 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006664 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006665 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006666 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006667 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6668 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006669 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006670 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006671 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006672 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006673 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006674 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006675 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006676 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006677 }
6678}
6679
6680
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006681/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6682///
6683Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6684 Instruction *LHSI,
6685 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6686 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6687
6688 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00006689 case Instruction::Trunc:
6690 if (ICI.isEquality() && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6691 // Simplify icmp eq (trunc x to i8), 42 -> icmp eq x, 42|highbits if all
6692 // of the high bits truncated out of x are known.
6693 unsigned DstBits = LHSI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(),
6694 SrcBits = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6695 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(SrcBits, SrcBits-DstBits));
6696 APInt KnownZero(SrcBits, 0), KnownOne(SrcBits, 0);
6697 ComputeMaskedBits(LHSI->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
6698
6699 // If all the high bits are known, we can do this xform.
6700 if ((KnownZero|KnownOne).countLeadingOnes() >= SrcBits-DstBits) {
6701 // Pull in the high bits from known-ones set.
6702 APInt NewRHS(RHS->getValue());
6703 NewRHS.zext(SrcBits);
6704 NewRHS |= KnownOne;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006705 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006706 ConstantInt::get(*Context, NewRHS));
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00006707 }
6708 }
6709 break;
6710
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00006711 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006712 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6713 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6714 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006715 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6716 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006717 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6718
6719 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6720 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6721 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6722 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00006723 Worklist.Add(LHSI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006724 return &ICI;
6725 }
6726
6727 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6728 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6729
6730 // If so, the new one isn't.
6731 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6732
6733 if (isTrueIfPositive)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006734 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006735 SubOne(RHS));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006736 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006737 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006738 AddOne(RHS));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006739 }
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006740
6741 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6742 // (icmp u/s (xor A SignBit), C) -> (icmp s/u A, (xor C SignBit))
6743 if (!ICI.isEquality() && XorCST->getValue().isSignBit()) {
6744 const APInt &SignBit = XorCST->getValue();
6745 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.isSignedPredicate()
6746 ? ICI.getUnsignedPredicate()
6747 : ICI.getSignedPredicate();
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006748 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006749 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV ^ SignBit));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006750 }
6751
6752 // (icmp u/s (xor A ~SignBit), C) -> (icmp s/u (xor C ~SignBit), A)
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006753 if (!ICI.isEquality() && XorCST->getValue().isMaxSignedValue()) {
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006754 const APInt &NotSignBit = XorCST->getValue();
6755 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.isSignedPredicate()
6756 ? ICI.getUnsignedPredicate()
6757 : ICI.getSignedPredicate();
6758 Pred = ICI.getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006759 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006760 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV ^ NotSignBit));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006761 }
6762 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006763 }
6764 break;
6765 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6766 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6767 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6768 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6769
6770 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6771 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6772 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6773 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6774 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6775 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6776 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6777 // bit would not work.
6778 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006779 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6780 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006781 uint32_t BitWidth =
6782 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6783 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6784 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6785 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6786 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006787 Value *NewAnd =
6788 Builder->CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006789 ConstantInt::get(*Context, NewCST), LHSI->getName());
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006790 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006791 ConstantInt::get(*Context, NewCI));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006792 }
6793 }
6794
6795 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6796 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6797 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6798 // access.
6799 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6800 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6801 Shift = 0;
6802
6803 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6804 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6805 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6806 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6807
6808 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6809 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6810 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6811 if (ShAmt) {
6812 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6813 if (!CanFold) {
6814 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6815 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6816 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6817 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6818
6819 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6820 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6821 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6822 CanFold = true;
6823 }
6824
6825 if (CanFold) {
6826 Constant *NewCst;
6827 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006828 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006829 else
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006830 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006831
6832 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6833 // compared.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006834 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006835 NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006836 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6837 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6838 // result is always true or false now.
6839 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006840 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006841 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006842 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006843 } else {
6844 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6845 Constant *NewAndCST;
6846 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006847 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006848 else
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006849 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006850 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6851 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00006852 Worklist.Add(Shift); // Shift is dead.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006853 return &ICI;
6854 }
6855 }
6856 }
6857
6858 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6859 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6860 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6861 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
Chris Lattnere8e49212009-03-25 00:28:58 +00006862 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6863 !isa<Constant>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006864 // Compute C << Y.
6865 Value *NS;
6866 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006867 NS = Builder->CreateShl(AndCST, Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006868 } else {
6869 // Insert a logical shift.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006870 NS = Builder->CreateLShr(AndCST, Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006871 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006872
6873 // Compute X & (C << Y).
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006874 Value *NewAnd =
6875 Builder->CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006876
6877 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6878 return &ICI;
6879 }
6880 }
6881 break;
6882
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006883 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6884 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6885 if (!ShAmt) break;
6886
6887 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6888
6889 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6890 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6891 // simplified.
6892 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6893 break;
6894
6895 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6896 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6897 // comparison cannot succeed.
6898 Constant *Comp =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006899 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006900 ShAmt);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006901 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6902 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00006903 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context), IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006904 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6905 }
6906
6907 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6908 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6909 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6910 Constant *Mask =
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006911 ConstantInt::get(*Context, APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006912 TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006913
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006914 Value *And =
6915 Builder->CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006916 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006917 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006918 }
6919 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006920
6921 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6922 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6923 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6924 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6925 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006926 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(*Context, APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006927 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006928 Value *And =
6929 Builder->CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0), Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006930 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006931 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006932 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006933 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006934 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006935
6936 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006937 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006938 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006939 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006940 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006941
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006942 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6943 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6944 // simplified.
6945 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6946 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6947 break;
6948
6949 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006950
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006951 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6952 // comparison cannot succeed.
6953 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6954 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6955 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6956 else
6957 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6958
6959 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6960 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00006961 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context), IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006962 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6963 }
6964
6965 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6966 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6967 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006968 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6969 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006970 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006971 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006972 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006973 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006974
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006975 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006976 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6977 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006978 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(*Context, Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006979
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006980 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
6981 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006982 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006983 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006984 }
6985 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006986 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006987
6988 case Instruction::SDiv:
6989 case Instruction::UDiv:
6990 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6991 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6992 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6993 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6994 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6995 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006996 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6997 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6998 DivRHS))
6999 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007000 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007001
7002 case Instruction::Add:
7003 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
7004
7005 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
7006 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
7007 if (!LHSC) break;
7008 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
7009
7010 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
7011 .subtract(LHSV);
7012
7013 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
7014 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007015 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007016 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getUpper()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007017 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007018 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007019 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getLower()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007020 }
7021 } else {
7022 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007023 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007024 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getUpper()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007025 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007026 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007027 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getLower()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007028 }
7029 }
7030 }
7031 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007032 }
7033
7034 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
7035 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
7036 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7037
7038 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
7039 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
7040 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
7041 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
7042 case Instruction::SRem:
7043 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
7044 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
7045 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
7046 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007047 Value *NewRem =
7048 Builder->CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
7049 BO->getName());
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007050 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007051 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007052 }
7053 }
7054 break;
7055 case Instruction::Add:
7056 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
7057 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
7058 if (BO->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007059 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007060 ConstantExpr::getSub(RHS, BOp1C));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007061 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
7062 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
7063 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
7064 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
7065
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007066 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007067 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007068 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007069 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007070 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007071 Value *Neg = Builder->CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007072 Neg->takeName(BO);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007073 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007074 }
7075 }
7076 break;
7077 case Instruction::Xor:
7078 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
7079 // the explicit xor.
7080 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007081 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007082 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007083
7084 // FALLTHROUGH
7085 case Instruction::Sub:
7086 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
7087 if (RHSV == 0)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007088 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007089 BO->getOperand(1));
7090 break;
7091
7092 case Instruction::Or:
7093 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
7094 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
7095 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007096 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
7097 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007098 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007099 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007100 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007101 }
7102 break;
7103
7104 case Instruction::And:
7105 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
7106 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
7107 // comparison can never succeed!
7108 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007109 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007110 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007111 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007112
7113 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
7114 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007115 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007116 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007117 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007118
7119 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00007120 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007121 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007122 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007123 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
7124 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007125 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007126 }
7127
7128 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
7129 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
7130 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007131 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007132 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
7133 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007134 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007135 }
7136 }
7137 default: break;
7138 }
7139 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
7140 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
7141 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00007142 Worklist.Add(II);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007143 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007144 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV.byteSwap()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007145 return &ICI;
7146 }
7147 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007148 }
7149 return 0;
7150}
7151
7152/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
7153/// We only handle extending casts so far.
7154///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007155Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
7156 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007157 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
7158 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007159 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007160 Value *RHSCIOp;
7161
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007162 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
7163 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00007164 if (TD && LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
7165 TD->getPointerSizeInBits() ==
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007166 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
7167 Value *RHSOp = 0;
7168 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007169 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007170 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
7171 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
7172 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
7173 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00007174 RHSOp = Builder->CreateBitCast(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType());
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007175 }
7176
7177 if (RHSOp)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007178 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007179 }
7180
7181 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
7182 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007183 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
7184 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00007185 return 0;
7186
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007187 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
7188 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007189
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007190 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007191 // Not an extension from the same type?
7192 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007193 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
7194 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00007195
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007196 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00007197 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
7198 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
7199 return 0;
7200
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007201 // Deal with equality cases early.
7202 if (ICI.isEquality())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007203 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007204
7205 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
7206 // signed comparison.
7207 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007208 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007209
7210 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007211 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00007212 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007213
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007214 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
7215 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
7216 if (!CI)
7217 return 0;
7218
7219 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
7220 // reextended to DestTy.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007221 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
7222 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007223 Res1, DestTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007224
7225 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
7226 if (Res2 == CI) {
7227 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
7228 // For example, we might have:
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007229 // %A = sext i16 %X to i32
7230 // %B = icmp ugt i32 %A, 1330
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007231 // It is incorrect to transform this into
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007232 // %B = icmp ugt i16 %X, 1330
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007233 // because %A may have negative value.
7234 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007235 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
7236 // signless.
7237 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007238 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007239 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007240 }
7241
7242 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
7243 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
7244
7245 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
7246 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
7247 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007248 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007249 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007250 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007251
7252 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
7253 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
7254 Value *Result;
7255 if (isSignedCmp) {
7256 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00007257 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007258 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007259 else
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007260 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007261 } else {
7262 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
7263 if (isSignedExt) {
7264 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
7265 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007266 Constant *NegOne = Constant::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007267 Result = Builder->CreateICmpSGT(LHSCIOp, NegOne, ICI.getName());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007268 } else {
7269 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007270 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007271 }
7272 }
7273
7274 // Finally, return the value computed.
7275 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007276 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007277 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007278
7279 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
7280 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
7281 "ICmp should be folded!");
7282 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007283 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007284 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007285}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007286
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007287Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
7288 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
7289}
7290
7291Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
7292 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
7293}
7294
7295Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00007296 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
7297 return R;
7298
7299 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
7300
7301 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
7302 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
7303 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
7304 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
Dan Gohman0001e562009-02-24 02:00:40 +00007305
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007306 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
7307 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
7308 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())))
7309 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
7310
7311 // Arithmetic shifting an all-sign-bit value is a no-op.
7312 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op0);
7313 if (NumSignBits == Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())
7314 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Dan Gohman0001e562009-02-24 02:00:40 +00007315
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00007316 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007317}
7318
7319Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
7320 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007321 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007322
7323 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
7324 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007325 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
7326 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00007327 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007328
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007329 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
7330 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00007331 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007332 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007333 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007334 }
7335 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007336 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
7337 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
7338 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007339 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007340 }
7341
Dan Gohman9004c8a2009-05-21 02:28:33 +00007342 // See if we can fold away this shift.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007343 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Dan Gohman9004c8a2009-05-21 02:28:33 +00007344 return &I;
7345
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007346 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7347 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
7348 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007349 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007350 return R;
7351
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007352 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007353 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
7354 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007355 return 0;
7356}
7357
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007358Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007359 BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +00007360 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007361
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007362 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
7363 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007364 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007365
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007366 // shl i32 X, 32 = 0 and srl i8 Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate
7367 // a signed shift.
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007368 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007369 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00007370 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007371 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007372 else {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007373 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007374 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00007375 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007376 }
7377
7378 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
7379 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
7380 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
7381 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007382 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007383 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007384
7385 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7386 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
7387 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
7388 return R;
7389 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
7390 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
7391 return NV;
7392
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007393 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
7394 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
7395 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
7396 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
7397 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
7398 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
7399 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
7400 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
7401 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
7402 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
7403 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007404 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007405 // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
7406 Value *NSh = Builder->CreateBinOp(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,I.getName());
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007407
7408 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
7409 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
7410 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
7411 // other xforms later if dead.
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007412 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
7413 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007414 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
7415
7416 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
7417 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
7418 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
7419 // mask as appropriate.
7420 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
7421 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
7422 else {
7423 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
7424 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
7425 }
7426
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007427 // shift1 & 0x00FF
7428 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(*Context, MaskV),
7429 TI->getName());
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007430
7431 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
7432 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
7433 }
7434 }
7435
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007436 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007437 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
7438 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
7439 Value *V1, *V2;
7440 ConstantInt *CC;
7441 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007442 default: break;
7443 case Instruction::Add:
7444 case Instruction::And:
7445 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007446 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007447 // These operators commute.
7448 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007449 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007450 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007451 m_Specific(Op1)))) {
7452 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7453 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
7454 // (X + (Y << C))
7455 Value *X = Builder->CreateBinOp(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
7456 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007457 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007458 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context,
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007459 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007460 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007461
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007462 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007463 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00007464 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007465 match(Op0BOOp1,
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007466 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Specific(Op1)),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007467 m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007468 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007469 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7470 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
7471 Op0BO->getName());
7472 // X & (CC << C)
7473 Value *XM = Builder->CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
7474 V1->getName()+".mask");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007475 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007476 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007477 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007478
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007479 // FALL THROUGH.
7480 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007481 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007482 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007483 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007484 m_Specific(Op1)))) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007485 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7486 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
7487 // (X + (Y << C))
7488 Value *X = Builder->CreateBinOp(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
7489 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007490 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007491 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context,
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007492 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007493 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007494
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00007495 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007496 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7497 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
7498 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007499 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007500 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
7501 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007502 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7503 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
7504 // X & (CC << C)
7505 Value *XM = Builder->CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
7506 V1->getName()+".mask");
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007507
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007508 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007509 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007510
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007511 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007512 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007513 }
7514
7515
7516 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
7517 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
7518 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
7519 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
7520 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
7521
7522 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007523 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00007524 case Instruction::Add:
7525 isValid = isLeftShift;
7526 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007527 case Instruction::Or:
7528 case Instruction::Xor:
7529 highBitSet = false;
7530 break;
7531 case Instruction::And:
7532 highBitSet = true;
7533 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007534 }
7535
7536 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
7537 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
7538 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
7539 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
7540 // operation.
7541 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00007542 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007543 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007544
7545 if (isValid) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007546 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007547
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007548 Value *NewShift =
7549 Builder->CreateBinOp(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007550 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007551
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007552 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007553 NewRHS);
7554 }
7555 }
7556 }
7557 }
7558
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007559 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007560 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
7561 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
7562 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007563
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007564 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007565 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007566 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7567 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007568 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
7569 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
7570 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007571
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007572 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007573
7574 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
7575
7576 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00007577 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007578 // If this is oversized composite shift, then unsigned shifts get 0, ashr
7579 // saturates.
7580 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits) {
7581 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007582 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007583 AmtSum = TypeBits-1; // Saturate to 31 for i32 ashr.
7584 }
7585
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007586 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007587 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007588 }
7589
7590 if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
7591 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007592 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007594
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007595 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007596 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007597 }
7598
7599 if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
7600 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007601 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007602 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
7603 AmtSum = TypeBits-1;
7604
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007605 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007606
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007607 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007608 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007609 }
7610
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007611 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7612 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7613 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7614 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7615 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007616 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007617 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007618 }
7619 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7620 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00007621 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007622 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007623 }
7624 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7625 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7626 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7627 // generators.
7628 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7629 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007630 case 1 :
7631 case 8 :
7632 case 16 :
7633 case 32 :
7634 case 64 :
7635 case 128:
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007636 SExtType = IntegerType::get(*Context, Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007637 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007638 default: break;
7639 }
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007640 if (SExtType)
7641 return new SExtInst(Builder->CreateTrunc(X, SExtType, "sext"), Ty);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007642 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7643 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007644 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007645
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007646 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007647 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7648 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7649 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007650 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007651
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007652 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007653 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
7654 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007655 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007656
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007657 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007658 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7659 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007660 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007661
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00007662 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007663 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
7664 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007665 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007666
7667 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7668 } else {
7669 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007670 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007671
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007672 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007673 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7674 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7675 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007676 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateBinOp(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
7677 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007678
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007679 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007680 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
7681 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007682 }
7683
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007684 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007685 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7686 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007687 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007688
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00007689 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007690 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
7691 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007692 }
7693
7694 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007695 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007696 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007697 return 0;
7698}
7699
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007700
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007701/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7702/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7703/// X*Scale+Offset.
7704///
7705static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00007706 int &Offset, LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007707 assert(Val->getType() == Type::getInt32Ty(*Context) &&
7708 "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007709 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007710 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007711 Scale = 0;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007712 return ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007713 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7714 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7715 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7716 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7717 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7718 Offset = 0;
7719 return I->getOperand(0);
7720 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7721 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7722 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7723 Offset = 0;
7724 return I->getOperand(0);
7725 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7726 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7727 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7728 unsigned SubScale;
7729 Value *SubVal =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007730 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale,
7731 Offset, Context);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007732 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7733 Scale = SubScale;
7734 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007735 }
7736 }
7737 }
7738
7739 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7740 Scale = 1;
7741 Offset = 0;
7742 return Val;
7743}
7744
7745
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007746/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7747/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007748Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +00007749 AllocaInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007750 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007751
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007752 BuilderTy AllocaBuilder(*Builder);
7753 AllocaBuilder.SetInsertPoint(AI.getParent(), &AI);
7754
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007755 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7756 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00007757
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007758 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7759 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7760 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7761 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7762 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7763
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007764 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +00007765 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *User << '\n');
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007766 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007767 }
7768 }
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00007769
7770 // This requires TargetData to get the alloca alignment and size information.
7771 if (!TD) return 0;
7772
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007773 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7774 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7775 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7776 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007777
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007778 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7779 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007780 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7781
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007782 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7783 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
Dale Johannesena0a66372009-03-05 00:39:02 +00007784 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds. (A reference
7785 // from a dbg.declare doesn't count as a use for this purpose.)
7786 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && !hasOneUsePlusDeclare(&AI) &&
7787 CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007788
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00007789 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AllocElTy);
7790 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007791 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007792
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007793 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7794 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007795 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7796 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007797 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007798 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale,
7799 ArrayOffset, Context);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007800
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007801 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7802 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007803 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7804 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007805
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007806 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7807 Value *Amt = 0;
7808 if (Scale == 1) {
7809 Amt = NumElements;
7810 } else {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007811 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Scale);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007812 // Insert before the alloca, not before the cast.
7813 Amt = AllocaBuilder.CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007814 }
7815
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007816 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007817 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Offset, true);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007818 Amt = AllocaBuilder.CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007819 }
7820
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +00007821 AllocaInst *New = AllocaBuilder.CreateAlloca(CastElTy, Amt);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007822 New->setAlignment(AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007823 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007824
Dale Johannesena0a66372009-03-05 00:39:02 +00007825 // If the allocation has one real use plus a dbg.declare, just remove the
7826 // declare.
7827 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(&AI)) {
7828 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
7829 }
7830 // If the allocation has multiple real uses, insert a cast and change all
7831 // things that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it
7832 // will die soon.
7833 else if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007834 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7835 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007836 Value *NewCast = AllocaBuilder.CreateBitCast(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007837 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7838 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007839 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7840}
7841
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007842/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007843/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7844/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7845/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7846/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7847///
7848/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7849/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007850///
7851/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7852/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7853/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7854/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7855/// efficiently truncated.
7856///
7857/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7858/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7859/// the final result.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007860bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007861 unsigned CastOpc,
7862 int &NumCastsRemoved){
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007863 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007864 if (isa<Constant>(V))
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007865 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007866
7867 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007868 if (!I) return false;
7869
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007870 const Type *OrigTy = V->getType();
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007871
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007872 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7873 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7874 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7875 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7876 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7877 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7878 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7879 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007880 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007881 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7882 return true;
7883 }
7884 }
7885
7886 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7887 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7888 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7889
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007890 unsigned Opc = I->getOpcode();
7891 switch (Opc) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007892 case Instruction::Add:
7893 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007894 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007895 case Instruction::And:
7896 case Instruction::Or:
7897 case Instruction::Xor:
7898 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007899 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007900 NumCastsRemoved) &&
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007901 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007902 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007903
Eli Friedman070a9812009-07-13 22:46:01 +00007904 case Instruction::UDiv:
7905 case Instruction::URem: {
7906 // UDiv and URem can be truncated if all the truncated bits are zero.
7907 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
7908 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
7909 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth) {
7910 APInt Mask = APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth);
7911 if (MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0), Mask) &&
7912 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(1), Mask)) {
7913 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7914 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7915 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7916 NumCastsRemoved);
7917 }
7918 }
7919 break;
7920 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007921 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007922 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7923 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7924 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007925 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
7926 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits() &&
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007927 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007928 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007929 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007930 }
7931 break;
7932 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007933 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7934 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7935 // already zeros.
7936 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007937 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
7938 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007939 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007940 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007941 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7942 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007943 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007944 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007945 }
7946 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007947 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007948 case Instruction::ZExt:
7949 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007950 case Instruction::Trunc:
7951 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007952 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7953 // of casts in the input.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007954 if (Opc == CastOpc)
7955 return true;
7956
7957 // sext (zext ty1), ty2 -> zext ty2
Evan Cheng661d9c32009-01-15 17:09:07 +00007958 if (CastOpc == Instruction::SExt && Opc == Instruction::ZExt)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007959 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007960 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007961 case Instruction::Select: {
7962 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7963 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007964 NumCastsRemoved) &&
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007965 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007966 NumCastsRemoved);
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007967 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007968 case Instruction::PHI: {
7969 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7970 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7971 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7972 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007973 NumCastsRemoved))
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007974 return false;
7975 return true;
7976 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007977 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007978 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7979 break;
7980 }
7981
7982 return false;
7983}
7984
7985/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7986/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7987/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007988Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007989 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007990 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007991 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007992 isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007993
7994 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7995 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007996 Instruction *Res = 0;
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007997 unsigned Opc = I->getOpcode();
7998 switch (Opc) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007999 case Instruction::Add:
8000 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00008001 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008002 case Instruction::And:
8003 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008004 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00008005 case Instruction::AShr:
8006 case Instruction::LShr:
Eli Friedman070a9812009-07-13 22:46:01 +00008007 case Instruction::Shl:
8008 case Instruction::UDiv:
8009 case Instruction::URem: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008010 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008011 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008012 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)Opc, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00008013 break;
8014 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008015 case Instruction::Trunc:
8016 case Instruction::ZExt:
8017 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008018 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008019 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
8020 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008021 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
8022 return I->getOperand(0);
8023
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008024 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008025 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008026 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008027 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008028 case Instruction::Select: {
8029 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
8030 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
8031 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
8032 break;
8033 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008034 case Instruction::PHI: {
8035 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
8036 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
8037 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8038 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
8039 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
8040 }
8041 Res = NPN;
8042 break;
8043 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008044 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008045 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008046 llvm_unreachable("Unreachable!");
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008047 break;
8048 }
8049
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008050 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008051 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
8052}
8053
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008054/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
8055Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00008056 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8057
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00008058 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008059 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008060 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008061 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
8062 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
8063 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
8064 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008065 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00008066 }
8067 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00008068
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008069 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008070 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
8071 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
8072 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008073
8074 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008075 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
8076 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
8077 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008078
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008079 return 0;
8080}
8081
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008082/// FindElementAtOffset - Given a type and a constant offset, determine whether
8083/// or not there is a sequence of GEP indices into the type that will land us at
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008084/// the specified offset. If so, fill them into NewIndices and return the
8085/// resultant element type, otherwise return null.
8086static const Type *FindElementAtOffset(const Type *Ty, int64_t Offset,
8087 SmallVectorImpl<Value*> &NewIndices,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008088 const TargetData *TD,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008089 LLVMContext *Context) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008090 if (!TD) return 0;
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008091 if (!Ty->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008092
8093 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
8094 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
8095 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008096 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType(*Context);
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008097 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008098 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(Ty)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008099 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
Chris Lattner31a69cb2009-01-11 20:41:36 +00008100 Offset -= FirstIdx*TySize;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008101
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008102 // Handle hosts where % returns negative instead of values [0..TySize).
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008103 if (Offset < 0) {
8104 --FirstIdx;
8105 Offset += TySize;
8106 assert(Offset >= 0);
8107 }
8108 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize && "Out of range offset");
8109 }
8110
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008111 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008112
8113 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
8114 while (Offset) {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008115 // Indexing into tail padding between struct/array elements.
8116 if (uint64_t(Offset*8) >= TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008117 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008118
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008119 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(Ty)) {
8120 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008121 assert(Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes() &&
8122 "Offset must stay within the indexed type");
8123
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008124 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008125 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Elt));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008126
8127 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
8128 Ty = STy->getElementType(Elt);
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00008129 } else if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008130 uint64_t EltSize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008131 assert(EltSize && "Cannot index into a zero-sized array");
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008132 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008133 Offset %= EltSize;
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00008134 Ty = AT->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008135 } else {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008136 // Otherwise, we can't index into the middle of this atomic type, bail.
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008137 return 0;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008138 }
8139 }
8140
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008141 return Ty;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008142}
8143
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008144/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
8145Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
8146 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8147
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008148 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008149 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
8150 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008151 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8152 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
8153 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
8154 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00008155 Worklist.Add(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008156 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
8157 return &CI;
8158 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008159
8160 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
8161 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
8162 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
8163 // non-type-safe code.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008164 if (TD && GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008165 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
8166 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008167 ConstantInt *OffsetV =
8168 cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008169 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
8170
8171 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
8172 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
8173 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
8174 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008175 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008176 if (FindElementAtOffset(GEPIdxTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD, Context)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008177 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
8178 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
8179 // two.
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +00008180 Value *NGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(GEP)->isInBounds() ?
8181 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(OrigBase,
8182 NewIndices.begin(), NewIndices.end()) :
8183 Builder->CreateGEP(OrigBase, NewIndices.begin(), NewIndices.end());
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008184 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008185
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008186 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
8187 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
8188 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
8189 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008190 }
8191 }
8192 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008193 }
8194
8195 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8196}
8197
Chris Lattnerddfa57b2009-04-08 05:41:03 +00008198/// isSafeIntegerType - Return true if this is a basic integer type, not a crazy
8199/// type like i42. We don't want to introduce operations on random non-legal
8200/// integer types where they don't already exist in the code. In the future,
8201/// we should consider making this based off target-data, so that 32-bit targets
8202/// won't get i64 operations etc.
8203static bool isSafeIntegerType(const Type *Ty) {
8204 switch (Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
8205 case 8:
8206 case 16:
8207 case 32:
8208 case 64:
8209 return true;
8210 default:
8211 return false;
8212 }
8213}
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008214
Eli Friedmaneb7f7a82009-07-13 20:58:59 +00008215/// commonIntCastTransforms - This function implements the common transforms
8216/// for trunc, zext, and sext.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008217Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
8218 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8219 return Result;
8220
8221 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8222 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8223 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008224 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
8225 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008226
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008227 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
8228 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00008229 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(CI))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008230 return &CI;
8231
8232 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
8233 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008234 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
8235 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008236 return 0;
8237
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008238 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008239 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008240 // Only do this if the dest type is a simple type, don't convert the
8241 // expression tree to something weird like i93 unless the source is also
8242 // strange.
8243 if ((isSafeIntegerType(DestTy->getScalarType()) ||
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008244 !isSafeIntegerType(SrcI->getType()->getScalarType())) &&
8245 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008246 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008247 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008248 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
8249 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
8250 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
8251 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008252 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008253 bool DoXForm = false;
8254 bool JustReplace = false;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008255 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
8256 default:
8257 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
8258 // get here because of the check above.
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008259 llvm_unreachable("Unknown cast type");
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008260 case Instruction::Trunc:
8261 DoXForm = true;
8262 break;
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008263 case Instruction::ZExt: {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008264 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008265 if (!DoXForm && 0) {
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008266 // If it's unnecessary to issue an AND to clear the high bits, it's
8267 // always profitable to do this xform.
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008268 Value *TryRes = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, false);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008269 APInt Mask(APInt::getBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize, DestBitSize));
8270 if (MaskedValueIsZero(TryRes, Mask))
8271 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, TryRes);
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008272
8273 if (Instruction *TryI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TryRes))
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008274 if (TryI->use_empty())
8275 EraseInstFromFunction(*TryI);
8276 }
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008277 break;
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008278 }
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008279 case Instruction::SExt: {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008280 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008281 if (!DoXForm && !isa<TruncInst>(SrcI) && 0) {
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008282 // If we do not have to emit the truncate + sext pair, then it's always
8283 // profitable to do this xform.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008284 //
8285 // It's not safe to eliminate the trunc + sext pair if one of the
8286 // eliminated cast is a truncate. e.g.
8287 // t2 = trunc i32 t1 to i16
8288 // t3 = sext i16 t2 to i32
8289 // !=
8290 // i32 t1
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008291 Value *TryRes = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, true);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008292 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(TryRes);
8293 if (NumSignBits > (DestBitSize - SrcBitSize))
8294 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, TryRes);
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008295
8296 if (Instruction *TryI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TryRes))
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008297 if (TryI->use_empty())
8298 EraseInstFromFunction(*TryI);
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008299 }
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008300 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008301 }
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008302 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008303
8304 if (DoXForm) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +00008305 DEBUG(errs() << "ICE: EvaluateInDifferentType converting expression type"
8306 " to avoid cast: " << CI);
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008307 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
8308 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008309 if (JustReplace)
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008310 // Just replace this cast with the result.
8311 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008312
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008313 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
8314 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008315 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown cast type!");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008316 case Instruction::Trunc:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008317 // Just replace this cast with the result.
8318 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8319 case Instruction::ZExt: {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008320 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008321
8322 // If the high bits are already zero, just replace this cast with the
8323 // result.
8324 APInt Mask(APInt::getBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize, DestBitSize));
8325 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Res, Mask))
8326 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8327
8328 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008329 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(*Context,
8330 APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008331 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008332 }
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008333 case Instruction::SExt: {
8334 // If the high bits are already filled with sign bit, just replace this
8335 // cast with the result.
8336 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Res);
8337 if (NumSignBits > (DestBitSize - SrcBitSize))
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008338 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8339
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008340 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008341 return new SExtInst(Builder->CreateTrunc(Res, Src->getType()), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008342 }
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008343 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008344 }
8345 }
8346
8347 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
8348 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
8349
8350 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
8351 case Instruction::Add:
8352 case Instruction::Mul:
8353 case Instruction::And:
8354 case Instruction::Or:
8355 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00008356 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008357 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
8358 // Don't insert two casts unless at least one can be eliminated.
8359 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008360 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008361 Value *Op0c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op0, DestTy, Op0->getName());
8362 Value *Op1c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op1, DestTy, Op1->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008363 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008364 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008365 }
8366 }
8367
8368 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
8369 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
8370 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00008371 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context) &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008372 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008373 Value *New = Builder->CreateZExt(Op0, DestTy, Op0->getName());
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008374 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008375 ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008376 }
8377 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008378
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008379 case Instruction::Shl: {
8380 // Canonicalize trunc inside shl, if we can.
8381 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1);
8382 if (CI && DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
8383 CI->getLimitedValue(DestBitSize) < DestBitSize) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008384 Value *Op0c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op0, DestTy, Op0->getName());
8385 Value *Op1c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op1, DestTy, Op1->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008386 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008387 }
8388 break;
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008389 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008390 }
8391 return 0;
8392}
8393
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008394Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008395 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8396 return Result;
8397
8398 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8399 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008400 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
8401 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008402
8403 // Canonicalize trunc x to i1 -> (icmp ne (and x, 1), 0)
Eli Friedman191a0ae2009-07-18 09:21:25 +00008404 if (DestBitWidth == 1) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008405 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(Src->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008406 Src = Builder->CreateAnd(Src, One, "tmp");
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008407 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(Src->getType());
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00008408 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Src, Zero);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008409 }
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008410
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008411 // Optimize trunc(lshr(), c) to pull the shift through the truncate.
8412 ConstantInt *ShAmtV = 0;
8413 Value *ShiftOp = 0;
8414 if (Src->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00008415 match(Src, m_LShr(m_Value(ShiftOp), m_ConstantInt(ShAmtV)))) {
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008416 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
8417
8418 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
8419 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
8420 if (MaskedValueIsZero(ShiftOp, Mask)) {
8421 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008422 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008423
8424 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
8425 // shift.
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008426 Value *V1 = Builder->CreateTrunc(ShiftOp, Ty, ShiftOp->getName());
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008427 Value *V2 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(ShAmtV, Ty);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008428 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008429 }
8430 }
8431
8432 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008433}
8434
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008435/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
8436/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
8437Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
8438 bool DoXform) {
8439 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8440 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8441 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8442 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
8443 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
8444
8445 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
8446 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
8447 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
8448 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
8449 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8450
8451 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008452 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008453 In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008454 In = Builder->CreateLShr(In, Sh, In->getName()+".lobit");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008455 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008456 In = Builder->CreateIntCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008457
8458 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008459 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008460 In = Builder->CreateXor(In, One, In->getName()+".not");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008461 }
8462
8463 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8464 }
8465
8466
8467
8468 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8469 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8470 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8471 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8472 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8473 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8474 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8475 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8476 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
8477 // This only works for EQ and NE
8478 ICI->isEquality()) {
8479 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
8480 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
8481 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8482 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
8483 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8484
8485 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
8486 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
8487 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8488
8489 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
8490 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
8491 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
8492 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008493 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context), isNE);
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008494 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008495 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8496 }
8497
8498 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
8499 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8500 if (ShiftAmt) {
8501 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
8502 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008503 In = Builder->CreateLShr(In, ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),ShiftAmt),
8504 In->getName()+".lobit");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008505 }
8506
8507 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008508 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008509 In = Builder->CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008510 }
8511
8512 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
8513 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8514 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008515 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008516 }
8517 }
8518 }
8519
8520 return 0;
8521}
8522
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008523Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008524 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
8525 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8526 return Result;
8527
8528 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8529
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008530 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
8531 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
8532 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
8533 if (TruncInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
8534 // Get the sizes of the types involved. We know that the intermediate type
8535 // will be smaller than A or C, but don't know the relation between A and C.
8536 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008537 unsigned SrcSize = A->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8538 unsigned MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8539 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008540 // If we're actually extending zero bits, then if
8541 // SrcSize < DstSize: zext(a & mask)
8542 // SrcSize == DstSize: a & mask
8543 // SrcSize > DstSize: trunc(a) & mask
8544 if (SrcSize < DstSize) {
8545 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008546 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(A->getType(), AndValue);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008547 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(A, AndConst, CSrc->getName()+".mask");
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008548 return new ZExtInst(And, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008549 }
8550
8551 if (SrcSize == DstSize) {
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008552 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008553 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, ConstantInt::get(A->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008554 AndValue));
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008555 }
8556 if (SrcSize > DstSize) {
8557 Value *Trunc = Builder->CreateTrunc(A, CI.getType(), "tmp");
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008558 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DstSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008559 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Trunc,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008560 ConstantInt::get(Trunc->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008561 AndValue));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008562 }
8563 }
8564
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008565 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
8566 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00008567
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008568 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
8569 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
8570 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
8571 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
8572 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
8573 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
8574 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
8575 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
8576 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008577 Value *LCast = Builder->CreateZExt(LHS, CI.getType(), LHS->getName());
8578 Value *RCast = Builder->CreateZExt(RHS, CI.getType(), RHS->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008579 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00008580 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008581 }
8582
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008583 // zext(trunc(t) & C) -> (t & zext(C)).
Dan Gohmana392c782009-06-17 23:17:05 +00008584 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && SrcI->hasOneUse())
8585 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1)))
8586 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0))) {
8587 Value *TI0 = TI->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008588 if (TI0->getType() == CI.getType())
8589 return
8590 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(TI0,
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008591 ConstantExpr::getZExt(C, CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmana392c782009-06-17 23:17:05 +00008592 }
8593
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008594 // zext((trunc(t) & C) ^ C) -> ((t & zext(C)) ^ zext(C)).
8595 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor && SrcI->hasOneUse())
8596 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1)))
8597 if (BinaryOperator *And = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI->getOperand(0)))
8598 if (And->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && And->hasOneUse() &&
8599 And->getOperand(1) == C)
8600 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(And->getOperand(0))) {
8601 Value *TI0 = TI->getOperand(0);
8602 if (TI0->getType() == CI.getType()) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008603 Constant *ZC = ConstantExpr::getZExt(C, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008604 Value *NewAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(TI0, ZC, "tmp");
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008605 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, ZC);
8606 }
8607 }
8608
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008609 return 0;
8610}
8611
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008612Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008613 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8614 return I;
8615
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008616 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8617
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008618 // Canonicalize sign-extend from i1 to a select.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008619 if (Src->getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008620 return SelectInst::Create(Src,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008621 Constant::getAllOnesValue(CI.getType()),
8622 Constant::getNullValue(CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008623
8624 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
8625 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +00008626 if (Operator::getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008627 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008628 unsigned OpBits = Op->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8629 unsigned MidBits = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8630 unsigned DestBits = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008631 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
8632
8633 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
8634 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
8635 // bits, it is already ready.
8636 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
8637 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
8638 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
8639 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
8640 // bits, just sext from i32.
8641 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8642 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8643 } else {
8644 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8645 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8646 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8647 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8648 }
8649 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008650
8651 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8652 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8653 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8654 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8655 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8656 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8657 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8658 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8659 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8660 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8661 // into:
8662 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8663 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8664 Value *A = 0;
8665 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8666 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00008667 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008668 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8669 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8670 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008671 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8672 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008673 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008674 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008675 I = Builder->CreateShl(I, ShAmtV, CI.getName());
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008676 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8677 }
8678 }
8679
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008680 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008681}
8682
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008683/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8684/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008685static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008686 LLVMContext *Context) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008687 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008688 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008689 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8690 if (!losesInfo)
Owen Anderson6f83c9c2009-07-27 20:59:43 +00008691 return ConstantFP::get(*Context, F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008692 return 0;
8693}
8694
8695/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8696/// through it until we get the source value.
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008697static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V, LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008698 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8699 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008700 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0), Context);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008701
8702 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8703 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8704 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8705 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008706 if (CFP->getType() == Type::getPPC_FP128Ty(*Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008707 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8708 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008709 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008710 return V;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008711 if (CFP->getType() == Type::getDoubleTy(*Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008712 return V; // Won't shrink.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008713 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008714 return V;
8715 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8716 }
8717
8718 return V;
8719}
8720
8721Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8722 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8723 return I;
8724
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008725 // If we have fptrunc(fadd (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008726 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008727 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to fadd/fsub/fmul/fdiv as well as
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008728 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8729 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8730 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8731 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8732 default: break;
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008733 case Instruction::FAdd:
8734 case Instruction::FSub:
8735 case Instruction::FMul:
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008736 case Instruction::FDiv:
8737 case Instruction::FRem:
8738 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008739 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0), Context);
8740 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1), Context);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008741 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8742 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008743 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008744 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8745 // the cast, do this xform.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008746 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8747 RHSTrunc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008748 LHSTrunc = Builder->CreateFPExt(LHSTrunc, CI.getType());
8749 RHSTrunc = Builder->CreateFPExt(RHSTrunc, CI.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008750 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008751 }
8752 }
8753 break;
8754 }
8755 }
8756 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008757}
8758
8759Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8760 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8761}
8762
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008763Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008764 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8765 if (OpI == 0)
8766 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8767
8768 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8769 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8770 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8771 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8772 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8773 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8774 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8775 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008776 (int)FI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008777 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8778 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008779
8780 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008781}
8782
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008783Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008784 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8785 if (OpI == 0)
8786 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8787
8788 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8789 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8790 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8791 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8792 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8793 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8794 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8795 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008796 (int)FI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <=
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008797 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8798 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008799
8800 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008801}
8802
8803Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8804 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8805}
8806
8807Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8808 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8809}
8810
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008811Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(PtrToIntInst &CI) {
8812 // If the destination integer type is smaller than the intptr_t type for
8813 // this target, do a ptrtoint to intptr_t then do a trunc. This allows the
8814 // trunc to be exposed to other transforms. Don't do this for extending
8815 // ptrtoint's, because we don't know if the target sign or zero extends its
8816 // pointers.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008817 if (TD &&
8818 CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008819 Value *P = Builder->CreatePtrToInt(CI.getOperand(0),
8820 TD->getIntPtrType(CI.getContext()),
8821 "tmp");
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008822 return new TruncInst(P, CI.getType());
8823 }
8824
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008825 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008826}
8827
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008828Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008829 // If the source integer type is larger than the intptr_t type for
8830 // this target, do a trunc to the intptr_t type, then inttoptr of it. This
8831 // allows the trunc to be exposed to other transforms. Don't do this for
8832 // extending inttoptr's, because we don't know if the target sign or zero
8833 // extends to pointers.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008834 if (TD && CI.getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() >
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008835 TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008836 Value *P = Builder->CreateTrunc(CI.getOperand(0),
8837 TD->getIntPtrType(CI.getContext()), "tmp");
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008838 return new IntToPtrInst(P, CI.getType());
8839 }
8840
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008841 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8842 return I;
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008843
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008844 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008845}
8846
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008847Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008848 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8849 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8850 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8851 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8852 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8853
Eli Friedman7e25d452009-07-13 20:53:00 +00008854 if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008855 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8856 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008857 } else {
8858 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8859 return Result;
8860 }
8861
8862
8863 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8864 // be replaced by the operand.
8865 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8866 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8867
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008868 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008869 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8870 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8871 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8872
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008873 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8874 // required for changing types.
8875 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8876 return 0;
8877
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00008878 // If we are casting a alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008879 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00008880 // There is no need to modify malloc calls because it is their bitcast that
8881 // needs to be cleaned up.
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +00008882 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(Src))
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008883 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8884 return V;
8885
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008886 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8887 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008888 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008889 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008890 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8891 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8892 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8893 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8894 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8895 ++NumZeros;
8896 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008897
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008898 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8899 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8900 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +00008901 return GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8902 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008903 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008904 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008905
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00008906 if (const VectorType *DestVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(DestTy)) {
8907 if (DestVTy->getNumElements() == 1) {
8908 if (!isa<VectorType>(SrcTy)) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008909 Value *Elem = Builder->CreateBitCast(Src, DestVTy->getElementType());
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00008910 return InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(DestTy), Elem,
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008911 Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00008912 }
8913 // FIXME: Canonicalize bitcast(insertelement) -> insertelement(bitcast)
8914 }
8915 }
8916
8917 if (const VectorType *SrcVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(SrcTy)) {
8918 if (SrcVTy->getNumElements() == 1) {
8919 if (!isa<VectorType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008920 Value *Elem =
8921 Builder->CreateExtractElement(Src,
8922 Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00008923 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Elem, DestTy);
8924 }
8925 }
8926 }
8927
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008928 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8929 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8930 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8931 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008932 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00008933 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
8934 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() &&
8935 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() ==
8936 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008937 CastInst *Tmp;
8938 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8939 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8940 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8941 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8942 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8943 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8944 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008945 Value *LHS = Builder->CreateBitCast(SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy);
8946 Value *RHS = Builder->CreateBitCast(SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008947 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8948 // know the vector types match #elts.
8949 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00008950 }
8951 }
8952 }
8953 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00008954 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008955}
8956
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008957/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8958/// %C = or %A, %B
8959/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8960/// into:
8961/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8962/// %D = or %A, %C
8963///
8964/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8965/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8966/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8967///
8968static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8969 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8970 case Instruction::Add:
8971 case Instruction::Mul:
8972 case Instruction::And:
8973 case Instruction::Or:
8974 case Instruction::Xor:
8975 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8976 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8977 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008978 case Instruction::LShr:
8979 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008980 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008981 default:
8982 return 0; // Cannot fold
8983 }
8984}
8985
8986/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8987/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008988static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008989 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008990 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008991 default: llvm_unreachable("This cannot happen!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008992 case Instruction::Add:
8993 case Instruction::Sub:
8994 case Instruction::Or:
8995 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008996 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008997 case Instruction::LShr:
8998 case Instruction::AShr:
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008999 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009000 case Instruction::And:
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00009001 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009002 case Instruction::Mul:
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009003 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009004 }
9005}
9006
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009007/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
9008/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
9009Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
9010 Instruction *FI) {
9011 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
9012 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
9013 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009014 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009015 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
9016 return 0;
9017 } else {
9018 return 0; // unknown unary op.
9019 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009020
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009021 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009022 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +00009023 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009024 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009025 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009026 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009027 }
9028
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009029 // Only handle binary operators here.
9030 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009031 return 0;
9032
9033 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
9034 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
9035 bool MatchIsOpZero;
9036 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
9037 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
9038 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
9039 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
9040 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9041 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
9042 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
9043 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
9044 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
9045 MatchIsOpZero = false;
9046 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
9047 return 0;
9048 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
9049 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
9050 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
9051 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
9052 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9053 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
9054 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
9055 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
9056 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
9057 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9058 } else {
9059 return 0;
9060 }
9061
9062 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009063 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
9064 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009065 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
9066
9067 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
9068 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009069 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009070 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009071 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009072 }
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009073 llvm_unreachable("Shouldn't get here");
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00009074 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009075}
9076
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009077static bool isSelect01(Constant *C1, Constant *C2) {
9078 ConstantInt *C1I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C1);
9079 if (!C1I)
9080 return false;
9081 ConstantInt *C2I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C2);
9082 if (!C2I)
9083 return false;
9084 return (C1I->isZero() || C1I->isOne()) && (C2I->isZero() || C2I->isOne());
9085}
9086
9087/// FoldSelectIntoOp - Try fold the select into one of the operands to
9088/// facilitate further optimization.
9089Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value *TrueVal,
9090 Value *FalseVal) {
9091 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
9092 // transformation we are doing here.
9093 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal)) {
9094 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9095 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal)) {
9096 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
9097 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9098 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
9099 OpToFold = 1;
9100 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
9101 OpToFold = 2;
9102 }
9103
9104 if (OpToFold) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009105 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI, Context);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009106 Value *OOp = TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
9107 // Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
9108 // between 0 and 1.
9109 if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
9110 Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OOp, C);
9111 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
9112 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
9113 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
9114 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009115 llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009116 }
9117 }
9118 }
9119 }
9120 }
9121
9122 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal)) {
9123 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9124 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal)) {
9125 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
9126 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9127 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
9128 OpToFold = 1;
9129 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
9130 OpToFold = 2;
9131 }
9132
9133 if (OpToFold) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009134 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI, Context);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009135 Value *OOp = FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
9136 // Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
9137 // between 0 and 1.
9138 if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
9139 Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C, OOp);
9140 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
9141 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
9142 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
9143 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009144 llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009145 }
9146 }
9147 }
9148 }
9149 }
9150
9151 return 0;
9152}
9153
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009154/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
9155/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
9156///
9157Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
9158 ICmpInst *ICI) {
9159 bool Changed = false;
9160 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
9161 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
9162 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
9163 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
9164 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
9165
9166 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
9167 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
9168 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
9169 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009170 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009171 switch (Pred) {
9172 default: break;
9173 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
9174 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
9175 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
9176 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
9177 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9178 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00009179 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009180 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
9181 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
9182 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9183 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
9184 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
9185 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
9186 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
9187 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
9188 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
9189 Changed = true;
9190 }
9191 break;
9192 }
9193 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
9194 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
9195 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
9196 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
9197 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9198 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00009199 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009200 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
9201 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
9202 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9203 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
9204 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
9205 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
9206 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
9207 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
9208 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
9209 Changed = true;
9210 }
9211 break;
9212 }
9213 }
9214
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009215 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
9216 // (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009217 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009218 if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>()) &&
9219 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<0>()))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009220 Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009221 else if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<0>()) &&
9222 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>()))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009223 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
9224
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009225 if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
9226 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
9227 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
9228 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
9229 const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
9230
9231 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
9232 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
9233 if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009234 (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009235 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009236 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009237 In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009238 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +00009239 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009240 *ICI);
Dan Gohman21440ac2008-11-02 00:17:33 +00009241 if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
9242 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009243 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
9244
9245 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009246 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009247 In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
9248
9249 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
9250 }
9251 }
9252 }
9253
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009254 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
9255 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
9256 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9257 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9258 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
9259 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9260 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9261 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
9262
9263 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
9264 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
9265 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9266 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9267 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
9268 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9269 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9270 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
9271 }
9272
9273 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
9274
9275 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
9276}
9277
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00009278
Chris Lattner7f239582009-10-22 00:17:26 +00009279/// CanSelectOperandBeMappingIntoPredBlock - SI is a select whose condition is a
9280/// PHI node (but the two may be in different blocks). See if the true/false
9281/// values (V) are live in all of the predecessor blocks of the PHI. For
9282/// example, cases like this cannot be mapped:
9283///
9284/// X = phi [ C1, BB1], [C2, BB2]
9285/// Y = add
9286/// Z = select X, Y, 0
9287///
9288/// because Y is not live in BB1/BB2.
9289///
9290static bool CanSelectOperandBeMappingIntoPredBlock(const Value *V,
9291 const SelectInst &SI) {
9292 // If the value is a non-instruction value like a constant or argument, it
9293 // can always be mapped.
9294 const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
9295 if (I == 0) return true;
9296
9297 // If V is a PHI node defined in the same block as the condition PHI, we can
9298 // map the arguments.
9299 const PHINode *CondPHI = cast<PHINode>(SI.getCondition());
9300
9301 if (const PHINode *VP = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I))
9302 if (VP->getParent() == CondPHI->getParent())
9303 return true;
9304
9305 // Otherwise, if the PHI and select are defined in the same block and if V is
9306 // defined in a different block, then we can transform it.
9307 if (SI.getParent() == CondPHI->getParent() &&
9308 I->getParent() != CondPHI->getParent())
9309 return true;
9310
9311 // Otherwise we have a 'hard' case and we can't tell without doing more
9312 // detailed dominator based analysis, punt.
9313 return false;
9314}
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00009315
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009316Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009317 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
9318 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
9319 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
9320
9321 // select true, X, Y -> X
9322 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009323 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009324 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009325
9326 // select C, X, X -> X
9327 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
9328 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9329
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009330 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
9331 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9332 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
9333 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9334 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
9335 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
9336 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9337 else
9338 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9339 }
9340
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009341 if (SI.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context)) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009342 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009343 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009344 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009345 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009346 } else {
9347 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
9348 Value *NotCond =
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009349 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009350 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009351 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009352 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009353 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009354 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009355 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009356 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009357 } else {
9358 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
9359 Value *NotCond =
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009360 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009361 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009362 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009363 }
9364 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00009365
9366 // select a, b, a -> a&b
9367 // select a, a, b -> a|b
9368 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009369 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00009370 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009371 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009372 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009373
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00009374 // Selecting between two integer constants?
9375 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
9376 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009377 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009378 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009379 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009380 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009381 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00009382 Value *NotCond =
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009383 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00009384 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009385 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00009386 }
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009387
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009388 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009389 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009390 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009391 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
9392 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009393 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00009394 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009395 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
9396 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
9397 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009398 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
9399 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
9400 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009401 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
9402 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009403 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
9404 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009405 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009406 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009407 Value *V = ICA;
9408 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009409 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009410 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
9411 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
9412 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009413 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009414 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009415
9416 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009417 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
9418 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009419 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009420 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
9421 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
9422 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
9423 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
9424 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
9425 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
9426 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
9427 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
9428 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009429 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009430 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009431 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009432 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009433 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009434 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009435
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009436 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009437 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009438 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
9439 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
9440 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
9441 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
9442 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
9443 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
9444 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
9445 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
9446 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
9447 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9448 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009449 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009450 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
9451 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009452 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009453 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009454 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009455 }
9456
9457 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009458 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
9459 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
9460 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009461
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009462 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
9463 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
9464 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009465 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
9466
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009467 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
9468 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
9469 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
9470 return IV;
9471
9472 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
9473 // even legal for FP.
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009474 if ((TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
9475 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
9476 (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
9477 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009478 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009479 } else if ((FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
9480 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
9481 (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
9482 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009483 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
9484 }
9485
9486 if (AddOp) {
9487 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
9488 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
9489 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
9490 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
9491 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
9492 }
9493
9494 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009495 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
9496 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
9497 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
9498 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00009499 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009500 } else {
9501 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009502 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00009503 "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009504 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009505
9506 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
9507 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
9508 if (AddOp != TI)
9509 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
9510 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009511 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
9512 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009513
9514 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009515 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009516 }
9517 }
9518 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009519
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009520 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00009521 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009522 Instruction *FoldI = FoldSelectIntoOp(SI, TrueVal, FalseVal);
9523 if (FoldI)
9524 return FoldI;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009525 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00009526
Chris Lattner7f239582009-10-22 00:17:26 +00009527 // See if we can fold the select into a phi node if the condition is a select.
9528 if (isa<PHINode>(SI.getCondition()))
9529 // The true/false values have to be live in the PHI predecessor's blocks.
9530 if (CanSelectOperandBeMappingIntoPredBlock(TrueVal, SI) &&
9531 CanSelectOperandBeMappingIntoPredBlock(FalseVal, SI))
9532 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(SI))
9533 return NV;
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00009534
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00009535 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
9536 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
9537 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
9538 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
9539 return &SI;
9540 }
9541
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009542 return 0;
9543}
9544
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009545/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
9546/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
9547/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
9548/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
9549/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
9550///
9551static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9552 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009553
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009554 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
9555 if (!U) return Align;
9556
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +00009557 switch (Operator::getOpcode(U)) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009558 default: break;
9559 case Instruction::BitCast:
9560 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
9561 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009562 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
9563 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00009564 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009565 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
9566 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009567 AllZeroOperands = false;
9568 break;
9569 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009570
9571 if (AllZeroOperands) {
9572 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009573 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009574 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009575 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009576 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009577 }
9578
9579 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
9580 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
9581 // of the global.
9582 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
Dan Gohmanecd0fb52009-02-16 23:02:21 +00009583 if (GV->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
9584 Align = GV->getAlignment();
9585 else {
9586 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9587 Align = PrefAlign;
9588 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009589 }
Chris Lattner42ebefa2009-09-27 21:42:46 +00009590 } else if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(V)) {
9591 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up.
9592 if (AI->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
9593 Align = AI->getAlignment();
9594 else {
9595 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9596 Align = PrefAlign;
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009597 }
9598 }
9599
9600 return Align;
9601}
9602
9603/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
9604/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
9605/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
9606/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
9607unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9608 unsigned PrefAlign) {
9609 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
9610 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
9611 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
9612 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
9613 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
9614 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
9615 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
9616
9617 if (PrefAlign > Align)
9618 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
9619
9620 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
9621 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009622}
9623
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009624Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009625 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohmanbc989d42009-02-22 18:06:32 +00009626 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009627 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009628 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment();
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009629
9630 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009631 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(MI->getAlignmentType(),
Owen Andersona547b472009-07-09 18:36:20 +00009632 MinAlign, false));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009633 return MI;
9634 }
9635
9636 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
9637 // load/store.
9638 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
9639 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
9640
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009641 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
9642 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
9643 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
9644 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009645 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009646 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
9647
9648 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009649 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009650
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009651 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009652 Type *NewPtrTy =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009653 PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(*Context, Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009654
9655 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
9656 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
9657 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
9658 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
9659 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
9660 // integer datatype.
9661 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
9662 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00009663 if (TD && SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009664 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
9665 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009666 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009667 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
9668 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
9669 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
9670 else
9671 break;
9672 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
9673 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
9674 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
9675 else
9676 break;
9677 } else
9678 break;
9679 }
9680
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009681 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +00009682 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009683 }
9684 }
9685
9686
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009687 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
9688 // infer, use it.
9689 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
9690 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
9691
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009692 Value *Src = Builder->CreateBitCast(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy);
9693 Value *Dest = Builder->CreateBitCast(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009694 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
9695 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
9696 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
9697
9698 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00009699 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009700 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009701}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009702
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009703Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
9704 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009705 if (MI->getAlignment() < Alignment) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009706 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(MI->getAlignmentType(),
Owen Andersona547b472009-07-09 18:36:20 +00009707 Alignment, false));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009708 return MI;
9709 }
9710
9711 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
9712 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
9713 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009714 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::getInt8Ty(*Context))
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009715 return 0;
9716 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009717 Alignment = MI->getAlignment();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009718
9719 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
9720 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
9721
9722 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
9723 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009724 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(*Context, Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009725
9726 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009727 Dest = Builder->CreateBitCast(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009728
9729 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
9730 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
9731
9732 // Extract the fill value and store.
9733 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009734 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009735 Dest, false, Alignment), *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009736
9737 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00009738 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009739 return MI;
9740 }
9741
9742 return 0;
9743}
9744
9745
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009746/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9747/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9748/// the heavy lifting.
9749///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009750Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Victor Hernandez66284e02009-10-24 04:23:03 +00009751 if (isFreeCall(&CI))
9752 return visitFree(CI);
9753
Chris Lattneraab6ec42009-05-13 17:39:14 +00009754 // If the caller function is nounwind, mark the call as nounwind, even if the
9755 // callee isn't.
9756 if (CI.getParent()->getParent()->doesNotThrow() &&
9757 !CI.doesNotThrow()) {
9758 CI.setDoesNotThrow();
9759 return &CI;
9760 }
9761
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009762 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9763 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9764
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009765 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9766 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009767 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009768 bool Changed = false;
9769
9770 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9771 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9772 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9773
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009774 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009775 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009776 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9777 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9778 // alignment is sufficient.
9779 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009780 }
9781
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009782 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9783 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9784 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009785 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009786 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9787 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9788 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00009789 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy;
9790 const Type *Tys[1];
9791 Tys[0] = CI.getOperand(3)->getType();
9792 CI.setOperand(0,
9793 Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID, Tys, 1));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009794 Changed = true;
9795 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009796
9797 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9798 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9799 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009800 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009801
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009802 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9803 // set, update the alignment.
Chris Lattner3ce5e882009-03-08 03:37:16 +00009804 if (isa<MemTransferInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009805 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9806 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009807 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9808 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9809 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009810 }
9811
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009812 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009813 }
9814
9815 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9816 default: break;
9817 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9818 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9819 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9820 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9821 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9822 break;
9823 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9824 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9825 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9826 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9827 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9828 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9829 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9830 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009831 Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1),
9832 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009833 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009834 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009835 break;
9836 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9837 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9838 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9839 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9840 const Type *OpPtrTy =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +00009841 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009842 Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009843 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9844 }
9845 break;
9846 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9847 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9848 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009849 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9850 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9851 const Type *OpPtrTy =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +00009852 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009853 Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009854 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9855 }
9856 break;
9857
9858 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9859 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9860 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00009861 unsigned VWidth =
9862 cast<VectorType>(II->getOperand(1)->getType())->getNumElements();
9863 APInt DemandedElts(VWidth, 1);
9864 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
9865 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009866 UndefElts)) {
9867 II->setOperand(1, V);
9868 return II;
9869 }
9870 break;
9871 }
9872
9873 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9874 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9875 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9876 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009877
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009878 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9879 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9880 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9881 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9882 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9883 AllEltsOk = false;
9884 break;
9885 }
9886 }
9887
9888 if (AllEltsOk) {
9889 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009890 Value *Op0 = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType());
9891 Value *Op1 = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType());
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00009892 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009893
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009894 // Only extract each element once.
9895 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9896 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9897
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009898 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009899 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9900 continue;
9901 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9902 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9903
9904 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009905 ExtractedElts[Idx] =
9906 Builder->CreateExtractElement(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1,
9907 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Idx&15, false),
9908 "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009909 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009910
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009911 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009912 Result = Builder->CreateInsertElement(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
9913 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i, false),
9914 "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009915 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009916 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009917 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009918 }
9919 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009920
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009921 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9922 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9923 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9924 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9925 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9926 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9927 if (&*++BI == II)
9928 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009929 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009930 }
9931
9932 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9933 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9934 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9935 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9936 bool CannotRemove = false;
9937 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00009938 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) || isMalloc(BI)) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009939 CannotRemove = true;
9940 break;
9941 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009942 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9943 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9944 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9945 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9946 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9947 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9948 } else {
9949 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9950 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009951 CannotRemove = true;
9952 break;
9953 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009954 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009955 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009956
9957 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
9958 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
9959 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
9960 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9961 break;
9962 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009963 }
9964
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009965 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009966}
9967
9968// InvokeInst simplification
9969//
9970Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009971 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009972}
9973
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00009974/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
9975/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009976static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
9977 const CastInst * const CI,
9978 const TargetData * const TD,
9979 const int ix) {
9980 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
9981 return false;
9982
9983 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
9984 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
9985 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009986 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009987 return true;
9988
9989 const Type* SrcTy =
9990 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
9991 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9992 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
9993 return false;
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00009994 if (!TD || TD->getTypeAllocSize(SrcTy) != TD->getTypeAllocSize(DstTy))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009995 return false;
9996 return true;
9997}
9998
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009999// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
10000//
10001Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010002 bool Changed = false;
10003
10004 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
10005 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010006 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
10007
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010008 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010009
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +000010010 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
10011 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
10012 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
10013 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
10014 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +000010015 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
Duncan Sandsac53a0b2009-10-06 15:40:36 +000010016 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010017 OldCall);
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000010018 // If OldCall dues not return void then replaceAllUsesWith undef.
10019 // This allows ValueHandlers and custom metadata to adjust itself.
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000010020 if (!OldCall->getType()->isVoidTy())
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000010021 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +000010022 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
10023 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
10024 return 0;
10025 }
10026
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010027 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
10028 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
10029 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
10030 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +000010031 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
Duncan Sandsac53a0b2009-10-06 15:40:36 +000010032 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010033 CS.getInstruction());
10034
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000010035 // If CS dues not return void then replaceAllUsesWith undef.
10036 // This allows ValueHandlers and custom metadata to adjust itself.
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000010037 if (!CS.getInstruction()->getType()->isVoidTy())
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000010038 CS.getInstruction()->
10039 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010040
10041 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
10042 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010043 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +000010044 ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010045 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010046 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
10047 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010048
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010049 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
10050 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
10051 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
10052 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
10053
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010054 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
10055 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
10056 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +000010057 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010058 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
10059 // the call.
10060 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010061 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
10062 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
10063 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
10064 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
10065 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010066 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010067 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010068 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010069
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +000010070 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +000010071 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +000010072 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +000010073 Changed = true;
10074 }
10075
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010076 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010077}
10078
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010079// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
10080// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
10081//
10082bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
10083 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
10084 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010085 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
10086 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010087 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +000010088 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010089 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010090 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010091
10092 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
10093 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
10094 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
10095 //
10096 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
10097 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010098 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010099
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010100 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +000010101 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
10102
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010103 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010104 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000010105 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010106 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
10107 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010108 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || !TD ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010109 OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext())) &&
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010110 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || !TD ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010111 NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext()))))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +000010112 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010113
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010114 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010115 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000010116 !NewRetTy->isVoidTy() && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010117 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
10118
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010119 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010120 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010121 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +000010122 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
10123 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010124
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010125 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
10126 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
10127 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
10128 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
10129 if (!Caller->use_empty())
10130 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
10131 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
10132 UI != E; ++UI)
10133 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
10134 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +000010135 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010136 return false;
10137 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010138
10139 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
10140 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010141
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010142 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
10143 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
10144 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +000010145 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010146
10147 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010148 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
10149
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010150 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
10151 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010152 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010153
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010154 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
10155 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +000010156 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010157 (TD && ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) ||
10158 ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext())) &&
10159 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) ||
10160 ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext()))));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010161 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010162 }
10163
10164 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010165 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010166 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010167
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010168 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
10169 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010170 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010171 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
10172 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010173 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
10174 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010175 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +000010176 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010177 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010178 return false;
10179 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010180
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010181 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
10182 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
10183 std::vector<Value*> Args;
10184 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010185 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010186 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
10187
10188 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010189 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010190
10191 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
10192 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010193 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010194
10195 // Add the new return attributes.
10196 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010197 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010198
10199 AI = CS.arg_begin();
10200 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
10201 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
10202 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
10203 Args.push_back(*AI);
10204 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +000010205 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010206 false, ParamTy, false);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010207 Args.push_back(Builder->CreateCast(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp"));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010208 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010209
10210 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010211 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010212 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010213 }
10214
10215 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010216 // now.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010217 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000010218 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010219
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010220 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010221 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010222 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Daniel Dunbarce63ffb2009-07-25 00:23:56 +000010223 errs() << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
10224 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010225 } else {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010226 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010227 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
10228 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
10229 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
10230 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010231 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10232 CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false, PTy, false);
10233 Args.push_back(Builder->CreateCast(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp"));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010234 } else {
10235 Args.push_back(*AI);
10236 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010237
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010238 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010239 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010240 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010241 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010242 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010243 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010244
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010245 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
10246 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
10247
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000010248 if (NewRetTy->isVoidTy())
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010249 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010250
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +000010251 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),
10252 attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010253
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010254 Instruction *NC;
10255 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010256 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010257 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
10258 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +000010259 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010260 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010261 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010262 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
10263 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +000010264 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
10265 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +000010266 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +000010267 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010268 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010269 }
10270
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010271 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010272 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010273 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000010274 if (!NV->getType()->isVoidTy()) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010275 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010276 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010277 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +000010278
10279 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
10280 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
10281 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000010282 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +000010283 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
10284 } else {
10285 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
10286 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
10287 }
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +000010288 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010289 } else {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010290 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010291 }
10292 }
10293
Devang Patel1bf5ebc2009-10-13 21:41:20 +000010294
Chris Lattner931f8f32009-08-31 05:17:58 +000010295 if (!Caller->use_empty())
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010296 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattner931f8f32009-08-31 05:17:58 +000010297
10298 EraseInstFromFunction(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010299 return true;
10300}
10301
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010302// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
10303// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
10304//
10305Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
10306 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
10307 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
10308 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010309 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010310
10311 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
10312 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010313 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010314 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010315
10316 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
10317 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
10318
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +000010319 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010320 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
10321 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
10322
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010323 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010324 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010325 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
10326 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010327 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010328
10329 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
10330 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
10331 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010332 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010333 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
10334 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010335 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010336 break;
10337 }
10338
10339 if (NestTy) {
10340 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
10341 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
10342 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
10343
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010344 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010345 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010346
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010347 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010348 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
10349
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010350 // Add any result attributes.
10351 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010352 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010353
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010354 {
10355 unsigned Idx = 1;
10356 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
10357 do {
10358 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010359 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010360 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
10361 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
10362 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
10363 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010364 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010365 }
10366
10367 if (I == E)
10368 break;
10369
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010370 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010371 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010372 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010373 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010374 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010375
10376 ++Idx, ++I;
10377 } while (1);
10378 }
10379
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010380 // Add any function attributes.
10381 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
10382 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
10383
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010384 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
10385 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010386 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010387
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010388 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010389 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
10390
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010391 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010392 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010393 {
10394 unsigned Idx = 1;
10395 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
10396 E = FTy->param_end();
10397
10398 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010399 if (Idx == NestIdx)
10400 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010401 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010402
10403 if (I == E)
10404 break;
10405
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010406 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010407 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010408
10409 ++Idx, ++I;
10410 } while (1);
10411 }
10412
10413 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
10414 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000010415 FunctionType *NewFTy = FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010416 FTy->isVarArg());
10417 Constant *NewCallee =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000010418 NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000010419 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF,
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000010420 PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +000010421 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),
10422 NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010423
10424 Instruction *NewCaller;
10425 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010426 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
10427 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
10428 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
10429 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010430 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010431 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010432 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010433 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
10434 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010435 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
10436 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
10437 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
10438 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010439 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010440 }
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000010441 if (!Caller->getType()->isVoidTy())
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010442 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
10443 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000010444 Worklist.Remove(Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010445 return 0;
10446 }
10447 }
10448
10449 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
10450 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
10451 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
10452 Constant *NewCallee =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010453 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF :
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000010454 ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010455 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
10456 return CS.getInstruction();
10457}
10458
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010459/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(a,c)]
10460/// and if a/b/c and the add's all have a single use, turn this into a phi
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010461/// and a single binop.
10462Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10463 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010464 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010465 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010466 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10467 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
10468
10469 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
10470 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010471
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010472 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, and all have one use.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010473 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010474 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +000010475 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010476 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010477 // types or GEP's with different index types.
10478 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
10479 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010480 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010481
10482 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
10483 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
10484 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
10485 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
10486 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010487
10488 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
10489 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
10490 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010491 }
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010492
10493 // If both LHS and RHS would need a PHI, don't do this transformation,
10494 // because it would increase the number of PHIs entering the block,
10495 // which leads to higher register pressure. This is especially
10496 // bad when the PHIs are in the header of a loop.
10497 if (!LHSVal && !RHSVal)
10498 return 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010499
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010500 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform!
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000010501
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010502 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010503 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000010504 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010505 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010506 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
10507 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010508 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
10509 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010510 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
10511 LHSVal = NewLHS;
10512 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010513
10514 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010515 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
10516 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010517 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
10518 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010519 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
10520 RHSVal = NewRHS;
10521 }
10522
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010523 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010524 if (NewLHS || NewRHS) {
10525 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10526 Instruction *InInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10527 if (NewLHS) {
10528 Value *NewInLHS = InInst->getOperand(0);
10529 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10530 }
10531 if (NewRHS) {
10532 Value *NewInRHS = InInst->getOperand(1);
10533 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10534 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010535 }
10536 }
10537
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010538 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010539 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010540 CmpInst *CIOp = cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +000010541 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +000010542 LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010543}
10544
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010545Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10546 GetElementPtrInst *FirstInst =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
10547
10548 SmallVector<Value*, 16> FixedOperands(FirstInst->op_begin(),
10549 FirstInst->op_end());
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010550 // This is true if all GEP bases are allocas and if all indices into them are
10551 // constants.
10552 bool AllBasePointersAreAllocas = true;
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000010553
10554 // We don't want to replace this phi if the replacement would require
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010555 // more than one phi, which leads to higher register pressure. This is
10556 // especially bad when the PHIs are in the header of a loop.
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000010557 bool NeededPhi = false;
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010558
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010559 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, and all have one use.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010560 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
10561 GetElementPtrInst *GEP= dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10562 if (!GEP || !GEP->hasOneUse() || GEP->getType() != FirstInst->getType() ||
10563 GEP->getNumOperands() != FirstInst->getNumOperands())
10564 return 0;
10565
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010566 // Keep track of whether or not all GEPs are of alloca pointers.
10567 if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas &&
10568 (!isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) ||
10569 !GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()))
10570 AllBasePointersAreAllocas = false;
10571
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010572 // Compare the operand lists.
10573 for (unsigned op = 0, e = FirstInst->getNumOperands(); op != e; ++op) {
10574 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op) == GEP->getOperand(op))
10575 continue;
10576
10577 // Don't merge two GEPs when two operands differ (introducing phi nodes)
10578 // if one of the PHIs has a constant for the index. The index may be
10579 // substantially cheaper to compute for the constants, so making it a
10580 // variable index could pessimize the path. This also handles the case
10581 // for struct indices, which must always be constant.
10582 if (isa<ConstantInt>(FirstInst->getOperand(op)) ||
10583 isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(op)))
10584 return 0;
10585
10586 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op)->getType() !=GEP->getOperand(op)->getType())
10587 return 0;
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000010588
10589 // If we already needed a PHI for an earlier operand, and another operand
10590 // also requires a PHI, we'd be introducing more PHIs than we're
10591 // eliminating, which increases register pressure on entry to the PHI's
10592 // block.
10593 if (NeededPhi)
10594 return 0;
10595
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010596 FixedOperands[op] = 0; // Needs a PHI.
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000010597 NeededPhi = true;
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010598 }
10599 }
10600
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010601 // If all of the base pointers of the PHI'd GEPs are from allocas, don't
Chris Lattner21550882009-02-23 05:56:17 +000010602 // bother doing this transformation. At best, this will just save a bit of
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010603 // offset calculation, but all the predecessors will have to materialize the
10604 // stack address into a register anyway. We'd actually rather *clone* the
10605 // load up into the predecessors so that we have a load of a gep of an alloca,
10606 // which can usually all be folded into the load.
10607 if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas)
10608 return 0;
10609
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010610 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform. Insert PHI nodes for each operand
10611 // that is variable.
10612 SmallVector<PHINode*, 16> OperandPhis(FixedOperands.size());
10613
10614 bool HasAnyPHIs = false;
10615 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FixedOperands.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10616 if (FixedOperands[i]) continue; // operand doesn't need a phi.
10617 Value *FirstOp = FirstInst->getOperand(i);
10618 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstOp->getType(),
10619 FirstOp->getName()+".pn");
10620 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10621
10622 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(e);
10623 NewPN->addIncoming(FirstOp, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
10624 OperandPhis[i] = NewPN;
10625 FixedOperands[i] = NewPN;
10626 HasAnyPHIs = true;
10627 }
10628
10629
10630 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
10631 if (HasAnyPHIs) {
10632 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10633 GetElementPtrInst *InGEP =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10634 BasicBlock *InBB = PN.getIncomingBlock(i);
10635
10636 for (unsigned op = 0, e = OperandPhis.size(); op != e; ++op)
10637 if (PHINode *OpPhi = OperandPhis[op])
10638 OpPhi->addIncoming(InGEP->getOperand(op), InBB);
10639 }
10640 }
10641
10642 Value *Base = FixedOperands[0];
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000010643 return cast<GEPOperator>(FirstInst)->isInBounds() ?
10644 GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
10645 FixedOperands.end()) :
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +000010646 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
10647 FixedOperands.end());
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010648}
10649
10650
Chris Lattner21550882009-02-23 05:56:17 +000010651/// isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe to
10652/// sink the load out of the block that defines it. This means that it must be
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010653/// obvious the value of the load is not changed from the point of the load to
10654/// the end of the block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010655///
10656/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
10657/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
10658/// to a register.
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010659static bool isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010660 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
10661
10662 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
10663 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
10664 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010665
10666 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
10667 // profitable to do this xform.
10668 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
10669 bool isAddressTaken = false;
10670 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
10671 UI != E; ++UI) {
10672 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
10673 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
10674 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
10675 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
10676 }
10677 isAddressTaken = true;
10678 break;
10679 }
10680
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010681 if (!isAddressTaken && AI->isStaticAlloca())
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010682 return false;
10683 }
10684
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010685 // If this load is a load from a GEP with a constant offset from an alloca,
10686 // then we don't want to sink it. In its present form, it will be
10687 // load [constant stack offset]. Sinking it will cause us to have to
10688 // materialize the stack addresses in each predecessor in a register only to
10689 // do a shared load from register in the successor.
10690 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(L->getOperand(0)))
10691 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)))
10692 if (AI->isStaticAlloca() && GEP->hasAllConstantIndices())
10693 return false;
10694
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010695 return true;
10696}
10697
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010698
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010699// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
10700// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
10701// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
10702Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10703 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
10704
10705 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
10706 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
10707 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
10708 // code size and simplifying code.
10709 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
10710 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010711 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010712 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
10713 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +000010714 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010715 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
10716 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010717 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010718 if (ConstantOp == 0)
10719 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010720 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
10721 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
10722 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
10723 // load and the PHI.
10724 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010725 !isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LI))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010726 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010727
10728 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10729 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10730 // the path through the other successor.
10731 if (isVolatile &&
10732 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10733 return 0;
10734
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010735 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010736 return FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010737 } else {
10738 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
10739 }
10740
10741 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
10742 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10743 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
10744 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010745 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010746 return 0;
10747 if (CastSrcTy) {
10748 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
10749 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010750 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010751 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
10752 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010753 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
10754 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010755 !isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LI))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010756 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010757
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010758 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10759 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10760 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010761 if (isVolatile &&
10762 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10763 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010764
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010765 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
10766 return 0;
10767 }
10768 }
10769
10770 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
10771 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010772 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
10773 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +000010774 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010775
10776 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10777 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010778
10779 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010780 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10781 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
10782 if (NewInVal != InVal)
10783 InVal = 0;
10784 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10785 }
10786
10787 Value *PhiVal;
10788 if (InVal) {
10789 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
10790 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
10791 PhiVal = InVal;
10792 delete NewPN;
10793 } else {
10794 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10795 PhiVal = NewPN;
10796 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010797
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010798 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010799 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010800 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010801 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010802 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010803 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +000010804 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010805 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010806 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
10807
10808 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
10809 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
10810 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
10811 if (isVolatile)
10812 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
10813 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
10814
10815 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010816}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010817
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010818/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
10819/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010820static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
10821 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010822 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
10823 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
10824
10825 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010826 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010827 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +000010828
10829 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10830 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
10831 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010832
10833 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
10834 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010835
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010836 return false;
10837}
10838
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010839/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
10840/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
10841/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10842static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
10843 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
10844 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
10845 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
10846 return true;
10847
10848 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10849 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
10850 return false;
10851
10852 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
10853 // the value.
10854 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10855 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
10856 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
10857 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10858 return false;
10859 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
10860 return false;
10861 }
10862
10863 return true;
10864}
10865
10866
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010867// PHINode simplification
10868//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010869Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000010870 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010871 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000010872
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010873 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10874 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10875
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010876 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10877 // reducing code size.
10878 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010879 isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1)) &&
10880 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0))->getOpcode() ==
10881 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1))->getOpcode() &&
10882 // FIXME: The hasOneUse check will fail for PHIs that use the value more
10883 // than themselves more than once.
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010884 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10885 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10886 return Result;
10887
10888 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10889 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10890 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010891 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10892 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10893 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010894 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010895 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10896 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010897 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010898 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010899
10900 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10901 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10902 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10903 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10904 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10905 // late.
10906 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10907 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10908 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010909 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010910 }
10911 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010912
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010913 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10914 // same value, for example:
10915 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10916 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10917 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10918 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10919 {
10920 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10921 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10922 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10923 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10924 ++InValNo;
10925
10926 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10927 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10928
10929 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10930 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10931 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10932 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10933 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10934 break;
10935 }
10936
10937 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10938 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10939 // the value.
10940 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10941 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10942 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10943 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10944 }
10945 }
10946 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000010947 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010948}
10949
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010950Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010951 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000010952 // Eliminate 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' and 'getelementptr %P', they are noops.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010953 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010954 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010955
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010956 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010957 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010958
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010959 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
10960 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
10961 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
10962
10963 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010964 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010965
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010966 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010967 if (TD) {
10968 bool MadeChange = false;
10969 unsigned PtrSize = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
10970
10971 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
10972 for (User::op_iterator I = GEP.op_begin() + 1, E = GEP.op_end();
10973 I != E; ++I, ++GTI) {
10974 if (!isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) continue;
10975
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010976 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010977 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need. This
10978 // explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more obvious.
10979 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>((*I)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010980 if (OpBits == PtrSize)
10981 continue;
10982
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +000010983 *I = Builder->CreateIntCast(*I, TD->getIntPtrType(GEP.getContext()),true);
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010984 MadeChange = true;
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010985 }
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010986 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010987 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010988
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010989 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
10990 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
10991 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
10992 //
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +000010993 if (GEPOperator *Src = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010994 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
10995 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
10996 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
10997 //
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000010998 if (GetElementPtrInst *SrcGEP =
10999 dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src->getOperand(0)))
11000 if (SrcGEP->getNumOperands() == 2)
11001 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011002
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000011003 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011004
11005 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
11006 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000011007 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*Src), E = gep_type_end(*Src);
11008 I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000011009 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011010
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011011 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011012 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000011013 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
11014 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
11015 //
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000011016 Value *Sum;
11017 Value *SO1 = Src->getOperand(Src->getNumOperands()-1);
11018 Value *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011019 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011020 Sum = GO1;
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011021 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011022 Sum = SO1;
11023 } else {
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000011024 // If they aren't the same type, then the input hasn't been processed
11025 // by the loop above yet (which canonicalizes sequential index types to
11026 // intptr_t). Just avoid transforming this until the input has been
11027 // normalized.
11028 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType())
11029 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011030 Sum = Builder->CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011031 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011032
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000011033 // Update the GEP in place if possible.
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000011034 if (Src->getNumOperands() == 2) {
11035 GEP.setOperand(0, Src->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011036 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
11037 return &GEP;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011038 }
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000011039 Indices.append(Src->op_begin()+1, Src->op_end()-1);
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000011040 Indices.push_back(Sum);
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000011041 Indices.append(GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011042 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011043 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000011044 Src->getNumOperands() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011045 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000011046 Indices.append(Src->op_begin()+1, Src->op_end());
11047 Indices.append(GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011048 }
11049
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011050 if (!Indices.empty())
11051 return (cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() &&
11052 Src->isInBounds()) ?
11053 GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Src->getOperand(0), Indices.begin(),
11054 Indices.end(), GEP.getName()) :
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000011055 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src->getOperand(0), Indices.begin(),
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000011056 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner6e24d832009-08-30 05:00:50 +000011057 }
11058
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000011059 // Handle gep(bitcast x) and gep(gep x, 0, 0, 0).
11060 if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner6e24d832009-08-30 05:00:50 +000011061 assert(isa<PointerType>(X->getType()) && "Must be cast from pointer");
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000011062
Chris Lattner2de23192009-08-30 20:38:21 +000011063 // If the input bitcast is actually "bitcast(bitcast(x))", then we don't
11064 // want to change the gep until the bitcasts are eliminated.
11065 if (getBitCastOperand(X)) {
11066 Worklist.AddValue(PtrOp);
11067 return 0;
11068 }
11069
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000011070 // Transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
11071 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
11072 //
11073 // Likewise, transform: GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
11074 // into : GEP i8* X, ...
11075 //
11076 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
Chris Lattner6e24d832009-08-30 05:00:50 +000011077 if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011078 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
11079 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011080 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
11081 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType())) {
11082 // GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
11083 if (CATy->getElementType() == XTy->getElementType()) {
11084 // -> GEP i8* X, ...
11085 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices(GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011086 return cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
11087 GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(X, Indices.begin(), Indices.end(),
11088 GEP.getName()) :
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +000011089 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Indices.begin(), Indices.end(),
11090 GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000011091 }
11092
11093 if (const ArrayType *XATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType())){
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011094 // GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011095 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011096 // -> GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011097 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
11098 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
11099 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
11100 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
11101 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
11102 return &GEP;
11103 }
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011104 }
11105 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011106 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
11107 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011108 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
11109 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011110 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
11111 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011112 if (TD && isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011113 TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
11114 TD->getTypeAllocSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011115 Value *Idx[2];
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011116 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011117 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011118 Value *NewGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
11119 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()) :
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011120 Builder->CreateGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011121 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011122 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011123 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011124
11125 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011126 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011127 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011128 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011129
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011130 if (TD && isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::getInt8Ty(*Context)) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011131 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011132 TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011133
11134 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
11135 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
11136 Value *NewIdx = 0;
11137 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
11138 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
11139 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000011140 Scale = ConstantInt::get(cast<IntegerType>(NewIdx->getType()), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011141 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000011142 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011143 Scale = CI;
11144 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
11145 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
11146 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000011147 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
11148 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000011149 Scale = ConstantInt::get(cast<IntegerType>(Inst->getType()),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +000011150 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011151 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
11152 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
11153 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
11154 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
11155 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
11156 }
11157 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011158
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011159 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011160 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
11161 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
11162 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
Chris Lattner58b1ac72009-02-25 18:20:01 +000011163 if (ArrayEltSize && Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011164 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000011165 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011166 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011167 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Chris Lattner878daed2009-08-30 05:56:44 +000011168 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
11169 false /*ZExt*/);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011170 NewIdx = Builder->CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011171 }
11172
11173 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011174 Value *Idx[2];
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011175 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011176 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011177 Value *NewGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
11178 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()) :
11179 Builder->CreateGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011180 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
11181 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011182 }
11183 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011184 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011185 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011186
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011187 /// See if we can simplify:
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000011188 /// X = bitcast A* to B*
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011189 /// Y = gep X, <...constant indices...>
11190 /// into a gep of the original struct. This is important for SROA and alias
11191 /// analysis of unions. If "A" is also a bitcast, wait for A/X to be merged.
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011192 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(PtrOp)) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011193 if (TD &&
11194 !isa<BitCastInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) && GEP.hasAllConstantIndices()) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011195 // Determine how much the GEP moves the pointer. We are guaranteed to get
11196 // a constant back from EmitGEPOffset.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011197 ConstantInt *OffsetV =
11198 cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(&GEP, GEP, *this));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011199 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
11200
11201 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, just replace the GEP
11202 // with a bitcast of the real input to the dest type.
11203 if (Offset == 0) {
11204 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
11205 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +000011206 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) ||
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +000011207 isMalloc(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011208 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
11209 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
11210 if (I != BCI) {
11211 I->takeName(BCI);
11212 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
11213 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
11214 }
11215 return &GEP;
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011216 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011217 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011218 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011219 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011220
11221 // Otherwise, if the offset is non-zero, we need to find out if there is a
11222 // field at Offset in 'A's type. If so, we can pull the cast through the
11223 // GEP.
11224 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
11225 const Type *InTy =
11226 cast<PointerType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011227 if (FindElementAtOffset(InTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD, Context)) {
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011228 Value *NGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
11229 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
11230 NewIndices.end()) :
11231 Builder->CreateGEP(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
11232 NewIndices.end());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011233
11234 if (NGEP->getType() == GEP.getType())
11235 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, NGEP);
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011236 NGEP->takeName(&GEP);
11237 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, GEP.getType());
11238 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011239 }
11240 }
11241
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011242 return 0;
11243}
11244
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +000011245Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocaInst(AllocaInst &AI) {
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011246 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011247 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011248 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
11249 const Type *NewTy =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000011250 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Victor Hernandeza276c602009-10-17 01:18:07 +000011251 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +000011252 AllocaInst *New = Builder->CreateAlloca(NewTy, 0, AI.getName());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011253 New->setAlignment(AI.getAlignment());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011254
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011255 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
Dale Johannesena8915182009-03-11 22:19:43 +000011256 // allocas if possible...also skip interleaved debug info
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011257 //
11258 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
Victor Hernandez7b929da2009-10-23 21:09:37 +000011259 while (isa<AllocaInst>(*It) || isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(*It)) ++It;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011260
11261 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
11262 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
11263 //
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011264 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011265 Value *Idx[2];
11266 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
11267 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011268 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
11269 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011270
11271 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
11272 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011273 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011274 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011275 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011276 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011277 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011278
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011279 if (TD && isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized()) {
Dan Gohman6893cd72009-01-13 20:18:38 +000011280 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
Chris Lattner46d232d2009-03-17 17:55:15 +000011281 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate
11282 // and return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011283 if (TD->getTypeAllocSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011284 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Dan Gohman6893cd72009-01-13 20:18:38 +000011285
11286 // If the alignment is 0 (unspecified), assign it the preferred alignment.
11287 if (AI.getAlignment() == 0)
11288 AI.setAlignment(TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI.getAllocatedType()));
11289 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011290
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011291 return 0;
11292}
11293
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000011294Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
11295 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
11296
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011297 // free undef -> unreachable.
11298 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
11299 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +000011300 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
Duncan Sandsac53a0b2009-10-06 15:40:36 +000011301 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011302 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11303 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011304
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000011305 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
11306 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011307 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011308 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011309
11310 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
11311 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
11312 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
11313 return &FI;
11314 }
11315
11316 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
11317 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
11318 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011319 Worklist.Add(GEPI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011320 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
11321 return &FI;
11322 }
11323 }
11324
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +000011325 if (isMalloc(Op)) {
11326 if (CallInst* CI = extractMallocCallFromBitCast(Op)) {
11327 if (Op->hasOneUse() && CI->hasOneUse()) {
11328 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11329 EraseInstFromFunction(*CI);
11330 return EraseInstFromFunction(*cast<Instruction>(Op));
11331 }
11332 } else {
11333 // Op is a call to malloc
11334 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
11335 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11336 return EraseInstFromFunction(*cast<Instruction>(Op));
11337 }
11338 }
11339 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000011340
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000011341 return 0;
11342}
11343
Victor Hernandez66284e02009-10-24 04:23:03 +000011344Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFree(Instruction &FI) {
11345 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(1);
11346
11347 // free undef -> unreachable.
11348 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
11349 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
11350 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
11351 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)), &FI);
11352 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11353 }
11354
11355 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
11356 // when lots of inlining happens.
11357 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
11358 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11359
11360 // FIXME: Bring back free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X) transform
11361
11362 if (isMalloc(Op)) {
11363 if (CallInst* CI = extractMallocCallFromBitCast(Op)) {
11364 if (Op->hasOneUse() && CI->hasOneUse()) {
11365 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11366 EraseInstFromFunction(*CI);
11367 return EraseInstFromFunction(*cast<Instruction>(Op));
11368 }
11369 } else {
11370 // Op is a call to malloc
11371 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
11372 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11373 return EraseInstFromFunction(*cast<Instruction>(Op));
11374 }
11375 }
11376 }
11377
11378 return 0;
11379}
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000011380
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011381/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011382static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011383 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011384 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011385 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000011386 LLVMContext *Context = IC.getContext();
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011387
Mon P Wang6753f952009-02-07 22:19:29 +000011388 const PointerType *DestTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType());
11389 const Type *DestPTy = DestTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011390 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Mon P Wang6753f952009-02-07 22:19:29 +000011391
11392 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the cast.
11393 if (DestTy->getAddressSpace() != SrcTy->getAddressSpace())
11394 return 0;
11395
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011396 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011397
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000011398 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011399 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011400 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
11401 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
11402 // constants.
11403 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
11404 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
11405 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000011406 Value *Idxs[2];
Chris Lattnere00c43f2009-10-22 06:44:07 +000011407 Idxs[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
11408 Idxs[1] = Idxs[0];
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000011409 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011410 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
11411 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
11412 }
11413
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011414 if (IC.getTargetData() &&
11415 (SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011416 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000011417 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
11418 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
11419 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011420 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
11421 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011422
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011423 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
11424 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
11425 // the result of the loaded value.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011426 Value *NewLoad =
11427 IC.Builder->CreateLoad(CastOp, LI.isVolatile(), CI->getName());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011428 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000011429 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011430 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011431 }
11432 }
11433 return 0;
11434}
11435
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011436Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
11437 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000011438
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011439 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011440 if (TD) {
11441 unsigned KnownAlign =
11442 GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(LI.getType()));
11443 if (KnownAlign >
11444 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
11445 LI.getAlignment()))
11446 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11447 }
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011448
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000011449 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011450 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011451 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011452 return Res;
11453
11454 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
11455 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000011456
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011457 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
11458 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
11459 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
11460 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011461 if (Value *AvailableVal = FindAvailableLoadedValue(Op, LI.getParent(), BBI,6))
11462 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, AvailableVal);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011463
Chris Lattner878e4942009-10-22 06:25:11 +000011464 // load(gep null, ...) -> unreachable
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011465 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
11466 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
11467 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
Chris Lattner8a67ac52009-08-30 20:06:40 +000011468 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) && GEPI->getPointerAddressSpace() == 0){
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011469 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
11470 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
11471 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
11472 // CFG.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011473 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011474 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011475 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011476 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011477 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011478
Chris Lattner878e4942009-10-22 06:25:11 +000011479 // load null/undef -> unreachable
11480 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
11481 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op) ||
11482 (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op) && LI.getPointerAddressSpace() == 0)) {
11483 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
11484 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
11485 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
11486 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
11487 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
11488 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011489 }
Chris Lattner878e4942009-10-22 06:25:11 +000011490
11491 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_cast global) -> cast (load global)
11492 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
11493 if (CE->isCast())
11494 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
11495 return Res;
11496
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011497 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011498 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
11499 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
11500 // exposes redundancy in the code.
11501 //
11502 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
11503 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
11504 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
11505 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
11506 // unconditionally.
11507 //
11508 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
11509 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000011510 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
11511 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011512 Value *V1 = Builder->CreateLoad(SI->getOperand(1),
11513 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val");
11514 Value *V2 = Builder->CreateLoad(SI->getOperand(2),
11515 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val");
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011516 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011517 }
11518
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000011519 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
11520 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
11521 if (C->isNullValue()) {
11522 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
11523 return &LI;
11524 }
11525
11526 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
11527 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
11528 if (C->isNullValue()) {
11529 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
11530 return &LI;
11531 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011532 }
11533 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011534 return 0;
11535}
11536
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000011537/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011538/// when possible. This makes it generally easy to do alias analysis and/or
11539/// SROA/mem2reg of the memory object.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011540static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
11541 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
11542 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
11543
11544 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011545 const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
11546 if (SrcTy == 0) return 0;
11547
11548 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011549
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011550 if (!DestPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(DestPTy))
11551 return 0;
11552
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011553 /// NewGEPIndices - If SrcPTy is an aggregate type, we can emit a "noop gep"
11554 /// to its first element. This allows us to handle things like:
11555 /// store i32 xxx, (bitcast {foo*, float}* %P to i32*)
11556 /// on 32-bit hosts.
11557 SmallVector<Value*, 4> NewGEPIndices;
11558
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011559 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
11560 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
11561 // constants.
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011562 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcPTy) || isa<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
11563 // Index through pointer.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011564 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*IC.getContext()));
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011565 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11566
11567 while (1) {
11568 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
Torok Edwin08ffee52009-01-24 17:16:04 +000011569 if (!STy->getNumElements()) /* Struct can be empty {} */
Torok Edwin629e92b2009-01-24 11:30:49 +000011570 break;
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011571 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11572 SrcPTy = STy->getElementType(0);
11573 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy)) {
11574 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11575 SrcPTy = ATy->getElementType();
11576 } else {
11577 break;
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011578 }
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011579 }
11580
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000011581 SrcTy = PointerType::get(SrcPTy, SrcTy->getAddressSpace());
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011582 }
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011583
11584 if (!SrcPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy))
11585 return 0;
11586
Chris Lattner71759c42009-01-16 20:12:52 +000011587 // If the pointers point into different address spaces or if they point to
11588 // values with different sizes, we can't do the transformation.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011589 if (!IC.getTargetData() ||
11590 SrcTy->getAddressSpace() !=
Chris Lattner71759c42009-01-16 20:12:52 +000011591 cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getAddressSpace() ||
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011592 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) !=
11593 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy))
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011594 return 0;
11595
11596 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
11597 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
11598 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
11599 Value *NewCast;
11600 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
11601 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
11602 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
11603 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
11604 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
11605 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
11606 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
11607 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
11608 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
11609 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011610 }
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011611
11612 // SIOp0 is a pointer to aggregate and this is a store to the first field,
11613 // emit a GEP to index into its first field.
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011614 if (!NewGEPIndices.empty())
11615 CastOp = IC.Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(CastOp, NewGEPIndices.begin(),
11616 NewGEPIndices.end());
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011617
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011618 NewCast = IC.Builder->CreateCast(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy,
11619 SIOp0->getName()+".c");
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011620 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011621}
11622
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011623/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
11624/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
11625/// value in code like this:
Dan Gohman0f8b53f2009-03-03 02:55:14 +000011626/// %t0 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011627/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
Dan Gohman0f8b53f2009-03-03 02:55:14 +000011628/// %t1 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011629/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
11630///
11631static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
11632 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
11633 if (A == B) return true;
11634
11635 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
Dan Gohman58cfa3b2009-08-25 22:11:20 +000011636 // This uses isIdenticalToWhenDefined instead of isIdenticalTo because
11637 // its only used to compare two uses within the same basic block, which
11638 // means that they'll always either have the same value or one of them
11639 // will have an undefined value.
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011640 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
11641 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
11642 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
11643 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
11644 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
Dan Gohman58cfa3b2009-08-25 22:11:20 +000011645 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalToWhenDefined(BI))
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011646 return true;
11647
11648 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
11649 return false;
11650}
11651
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011652// If this instruction has two uses, one of which is a llvm.dbg.declare,
11653// return the llvm.dbg.declare.
11654DbgDeclareInst *InstCombiner::hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V) {
11655 if (!V->hasNUses(2))
11656 return 0;
11657 for (Value::use_iterator UI = V->use_begin(), E = V->use_end();
11658 UI != E; ++UI) {
11659 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI))
11660 return DI;
11661 if (isa<BitCastInst>(UI) && UI->hasOneUse()) {
11662 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI->use_begin()))
11663 return DI;
11664 }
11665 }
11666 return 0;
11667}
11668
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011669Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
11670 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
11671 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
11672
11673 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011674 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011675 ++NumCombined;
11676 return 0;
11677 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011678
11679 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
11680 // alloca dead.
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011681 // If the RHS is an alloca with a two uses, the other one being a
11682 // llvm.dbg.declare, zapify the store and the declare, making the
11683 // alloca dead. We must do this to prevent declare's from affecting
11684 // codegen.
11685 if (!SI.isVolatile()) {
11686 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
11687 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011688 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11689 ++NumCombined;
11690 return 0;
11691 }
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011692 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
11693 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
11694 if (GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
11695 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11696 ++NumCombined;
11697 return 0;
11698 }
11699 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
11700 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
11701 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11702 ++NumCombined;
11703 return 0;
11704 }
11705 }
11706 }
11707 }
11708 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Ptr)) {
11709 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
11710 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11711 ++NumCombined;
11712 return 0;
11713 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011714 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011715
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011716 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011717 if (TD) {
11718 unsigned KnownAlign =
11719 GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(Val->getType()));
11720 if (KnownAlign >
11721 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
11722 SI.getAlignment()))
11723 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11724 }
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011725
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011726 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consecutive
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011727 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
11728 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
11729 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
11730 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
11731 --ScanInsts) {
Dale Johannesen0d6596b2009-03-04 01:20:34 +000011732 --BBI;
Dale Johannesencdb16aa2009-03-04 01:53:05 +000011733 // Don't count debug info directives, lest they affect codegen,
11734 // and we skip pointer-to-pointer bitcasts, which are NOPs.
11735 // It is necessary for correctness to skip those that feed into a
11736 // llvm.dbg.declare, as these are not present when debugging is off.
Dale Johannesen4ded40a2009-03-03 22:36:47 +000011737 if (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
Dale Johannesencdb16aa2009-03-04 01:53:05 +000011738 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011739 ScanInsts++;
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011740 continue;
11741 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011742
11743 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
11744 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011745 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() &&equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
11746 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011747 ++NumDeadStore;
11748 ++BBI;
11749 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
11750 continue;
11751 }
11752 break;
11753 }
11754
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011755 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
11756 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
11757 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
11758 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011759 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
11760 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011761 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11762 ++NumCombined;
11763 return 0;
11764 }
11765 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
11766 // may not be dead.
11767 break;
11768 }
11769
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011770 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000011771 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011772 break;
11773 }
11774
11775
11776 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011777
11778 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
Chris Lattner8a67ac52009-08-30 20:06:40 +000011779 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr) && SI.getPointerAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011780 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011781 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011782 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011783 Worklist.Add(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011784 ++NumCombined;
11785 }
11786 return 0; // Do not modify these!
11787 }
11788
11789 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
11790 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011791 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011792 ++NumCombined;
11793 return 0;
11794 }
11795
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011796 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
11797 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011798 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011799 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11800 return Res;
11801 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011802 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011803 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11804 return Res;
11805
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011806
Dale Johannesen4084c4e2009-03-05 02:06:48 +000011807 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block (possibly
11808 // excepting debug info instructions and the pointer bitcasts that feed
11809 // into them), and if the block ends with an unconditional branch, try
11810 // to move it to the successor block.
11811 BBI = &SI;
11812 do {
11813 ++BBI;
11814 } while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
11815 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType())));
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011816 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011817 if (BI->isUnconditional())
11818 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
11819 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011820
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011821 return 0;
11822}
11823
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011824/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
11825/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
11826/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11827///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011828/// Simplify things like:
11829/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
11830/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11831///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011832bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
11833 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
11834
11835 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
11836 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
11837 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011838 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011839
11840 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
11841 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011842 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
11843 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011844 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011845 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011846 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011847 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011848 return false;
11849
11850 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011851 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011852 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011853 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011854 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011855 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011856 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000011857
11858 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
11859 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
11860 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
11861 return false;
11862
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011863 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
11864 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011865 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011866 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011867 return false;
11868
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011869 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
11870 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
11871 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
11872 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011873 --BBI;
Dale Johannesen4084c4e2009-03-05 02:06:48 +000011874 // Skip over debugging info.
11875 while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
11876 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
11877 if (BBI==OtherBB->begin())
11878 return false;
11879 --BBI;
11880 }
11881 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011882 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
11883 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11884 return false;
11885 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011886 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011887 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
11888 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
11889 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
11890 return false;
11891
11892 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011893 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
11894 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011895 for (;; --BBI) {
11896 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
11897 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
11898 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11899 return false;
11900 break;
11901 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011902 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
11903 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
11904 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011905 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
11906 return false;
11907 }
11908
11909 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011910 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
11911 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011912 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
11913 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011914 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011915 return false;
11916 }
11917 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011918
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011919 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011920 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
11921 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011922 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011923 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
11924 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011925 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
11926 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011927 }
11928
11929 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
11930 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011931 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011932 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
11933 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
11934
11935 // Nuke the old stores.
11936 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11937 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
11938 ++NumCombined;
11939 return true;
11940}
11941
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011942
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011943Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
11944 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000011945 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011946 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
11947 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +000011948 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011949 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
11950 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11951 BI.setCondition(X);
11952 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11953 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11954 return &BI;
11955 }
11956
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011957 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
11958 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
11959 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011960 TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11961 BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse())
11962 if (FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
11963 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) {
11964 FCmpInst *Cond = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
11965 Cond->setPredicate(FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred));
11966
11967 // Swap Destinations and condition.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011968 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11969 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011970 Worklist.Add(Cond);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011971 return &BI;
11972 }
11973
11974 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
11975 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
11976 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011977 TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11978 BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse())
11979 if (IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
11980 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
11981 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) {
11982 ICmpInst *Cond = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
11983 Cond->setPredicate(ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred));
11984 // Swap Destinations and condition.
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011985 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11986 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011987 Worklist.Add(Cond);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011988 return &BI;
11989 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011990
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011991 return 0;
11992}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011993
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011994Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
11995 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
11996 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
11997 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
11998 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
11999 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
12000 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012001 SI.setOperand(i,
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000012002 ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000012003 AddRHS));
12004 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012005 Worklist.Add(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000012006 return &SI;
12007 }
12008 }
12009 return 0;
12010}
12011
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012012Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012013 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012014
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012015 if (!EV.hasIndices())
12016 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
12017
12018 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
12019 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012020 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012021
12022 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012023 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012024
12025 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
12026 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
12027 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
12028 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
12029 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
12030 // first index
12031 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
12032 else
12033 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
12034 }
12035 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
12036 }
12037 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
12038 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
12039 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
12040 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
12041 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
12042 exti != exte && insi != inse;
12043 ++exti, ++insi) {
12044 if (*insi != *exti)
12045 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
12046 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
12047 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
12048 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
12049 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
12050 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
12051 // with
12052 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
12053 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
12054 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
12055 }
12056 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
12057 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
12058 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
12059 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
12060 // with "i32 42"
12061 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
12062 if (exti == exte) {
12063 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
12064 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
12065 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
12066 // with
12067 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
12068 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
12069 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
12070 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000012071 Value *NewEV = Builder->CreateExtractValue(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
12072 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012073 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
12074 insi, inse);
12075 }
12076 if (insi == inse)
12077 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
12078 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
12079 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
12080 // i.e., replace
12081 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
12082 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
12083 // with
12084 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
12085 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
12086 exti, exte);
12087 }
12088 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
12089 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
12090 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
12091 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012092 return 0;
12093}
12094
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012095/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
12096/// is to leave as a vector operation.
12097static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
12098 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
12099 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012100 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012101 if (isConstant) return true;
12102 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
12103 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
12104 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
12105 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
12106 return false;
12107 return true;
12108 }
12109 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
12110 if (!I) return false;
12111
12112 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
12113 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
12114 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
12115 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
12116 return true;
12117 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
12118 return true;
12119 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
12120 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
12121 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
12122 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
12123 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012124 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
12125 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
12126 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
12127 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
12128 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012129
12130 return false;
12131}
12132
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000012133/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
12134///
12135/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
12136/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012137static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
12138 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
12139 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
12140 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
12141 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
12142 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
12143
12144 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012145 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000012146 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
12147 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012148 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
12149 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000012150 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012151 return Result;
12152}
12153
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012154/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
12155/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
12156/// extracted from the vector.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012157static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012158 LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012159 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
12160 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012161 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
12162 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012163 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012164
12165 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012166 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012167 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012168 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012169 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012170 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
12171 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12172 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012173 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
12174 return 0;
12175 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012176
12177 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
12178 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012179 if (EltNo == IIElt)
12180 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012181
12182 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
12183 // vector input.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012184 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo, Context);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012185 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012186 unsigned LHSWidth =
12187 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012188 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012189 if (InEl < LHSWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012190 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl, Context);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012191 else if (InEl < LHSWidth*2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012192 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - LHSWidth, Context);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012193 else
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012194 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012195 }
12196
12197 // Otherwise, we don't know.
12198 return 0;
12199}
12200
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012201Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000012202 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012203 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012204 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012205
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000012206 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012207 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012208 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012209
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012210 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000012211 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
12212 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
12213 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012214 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner4cb81bd2009-09-08 03:44:51 +000012215 for (unsigned i = 1; i != C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012216 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
12217 op0 = 0;
12218 break;
12219 }
12220 if (op0)
12221 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012222 }
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012223
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012224 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
12225 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012226 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012227 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner4cb81bd2009-09-08 03:44:51 +000012228 unsigned VectorWidth = EI.getVectorOperandType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012229
12230 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
12231 // crashing the code below.
12232 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012233 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012234
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012235 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
12236 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
12237 // property.
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012238 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012239 APInt UndefElts(VectorWidth, 0);
12240 APInt DemandedMask(VectorWidth, 1 << IndexVal);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012241 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012242 DemandedMask, UndefElts)) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012243 EI.setOperand(0, V);
12244 return &EI;
12245 }
12246 }
12247
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012248 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal, Context))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012249 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000012250
12251 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
12252 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
12253 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
12254 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
12255 if (const VectorType *VT =
12256 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
12257 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012258 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0),
12259 IndexVal, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000012260 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
12261 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012262 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012263
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012264 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner275a6d62009-09-08 18:48:01 +000012265 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
12266 // profitable to do so
12267 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
12268 if (I->hasOneUse() &&
12269 CheapToScalarize(BO, isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1)))) {
12270 Value *newEI0 =
12271 Builder->CreateExtractElement(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
12272 EI.getName()+".lhs");
12273 Value *newEI1 =
12274 Builder->CreateExtractElement(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
12275 EI.getName()+".rhs");
12276 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012277 }
Chris Lattner275a6d62009-09-08 18:48:01 +000012278 } else if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012279 // Extracting the inserted element?
12280 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
12281 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
12282 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
12283 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000012284 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) && isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +000012285 Worklist.AddValue(EI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012286 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
12287 return &EI;
12288 }
12289 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
12290 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
12291 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012292 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
12293 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012294 Value *Src;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012295 unsigned LHSWidth =
12296 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
12297
12298 if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012299 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012300 else if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth*2) {
12301 SrcIdx -= LHSWidth;
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012302 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
12303 } else {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012304 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000012305 }
Eric Christophera3500da2009-07-25 02:28:41 +000012306 return ExtractElementInst::Create(Src,
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000012307 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), SrcIdx,
12308 false));
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012309 }
12310 }
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +000012311 // FIXME: Canonicalize extractelement(bitcast) -> bitcast(extractelement)
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012312 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012313 return 0;
12314}
12315
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012316/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
12317/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
12318/// Otherwise, return false.
12319static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012320 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012321 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012322 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
12323 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012324 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012325
12326 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012327 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012328 return true;
12329 } else if (V == LHS) {
12330 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012331 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012332 return true;
12333 } else if (V == RHS) {
12334 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012335 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012336 return true;
12337 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12338 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
12339 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
12340 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
12341 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
12342
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012343 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
12344 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012345 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012346
12347 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
12348 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
12349 // transitively ok.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012350 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask, Context)) {
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012351 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012352 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012353 return true;
12354 }
12355 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
12356 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012357 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
12358 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012359 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012360
12361 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
12362 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
12363 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
12364 // transitively ok.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012365 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask, Context)) {
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012366 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
12367 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012368 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012369 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012370 } else {
12371 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012372 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012373 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012374
12375 }
12376 return true;
12377 }
12378 }
12379 }
12380 }
12381 }
12382 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
12383
12384 return false;
12385}
12386
12387/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
12388/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
12389/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012390static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012391 Value *&RHS, LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012392 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012393 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012394 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012395 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012396
12397 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012398 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012399 return V;
12400 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012401 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012402 return V;
12403 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12404 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
12405 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
12406 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
12407 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
12408
12409 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
12410 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
12411 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
12412 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012413 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
12414 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012415
12416 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
12417 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012418 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
12419 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012420 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS, Context);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012421 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012422 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012423 return V;
12424 }
12425
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012426 if (VecOp == RHS) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012427 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask,
12428 RHS, Context);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012429 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
12430 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
12431 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012432 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012433 }
12434 return V;
12435 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012436
12437 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
12438 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012439 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask,
12440 Context))
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012441 return EI->getOperand(0);
12442
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012443 }
12444 }
12445 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012446 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012447
12448 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
12449 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012450 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012451 return V;
12452}
12453
12454Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
12455 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
12456 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
12457 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
12458
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000012459 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
12460 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
12461 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012462
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012463 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
12464 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
12465 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
12466 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
12467 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012468 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000012469 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
12470 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012471 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012472
12473 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
12474 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
12475
12476 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012477 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012478
12479 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
12480 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
12481 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
12482 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
12483
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012484 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
12485 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
12486 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
12487 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012488 Value *RHS = 0;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012489 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS, Context);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012490 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012491 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012492 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS,
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000012493 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012494 }
12495 }
12496 }
12497
Eli Friedmanb9a4cac2009-06-06 20:08:03 +000012498 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(VecOp->getType())->getNumElements();
12499 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
12500 APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
12501 if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&IE, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts))
12502 return &IE;
12503
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012504 return 0;
12505}
12506
12507
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012508Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
12509 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12510 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012511 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012512
12513 bool MadeChange = false;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012514
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012515 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012516 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012517 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012518
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012519 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012520
12521 if (VWidth != cast<VectorType>(LHS->getType())->getNumElements())
12522 return 0;
12523
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012524 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
12525 APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
12526 if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000012527 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12528 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012529 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000012530 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012531
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012532 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
12533 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
12534 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
12535 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012536 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
12537 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
12538 }
12539
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012540 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
12541 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
12542 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012543 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012544 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012545 else {
12546 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012547 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012548 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012549 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012550 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012551 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012552 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Mask[i]));
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012553 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012554 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012555 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012556 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012557 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000012558 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012559 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12560 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012561 MadeChange = true;
12562 }
12563
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012564 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012565 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000012566
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012567 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
12568 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
12569 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
12570 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
12571
12572 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
12573 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000012574 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012575
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012576 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
12577 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
12578 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012579
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012580 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
12581 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
12582 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
12583 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
12584 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
12585 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
12586 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
12587 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
12588 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
12589 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
12590 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
12591 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
12592
12593 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
12594 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
12595 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
12596 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
12597 else
12598 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
12599
12600 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
12601 // the replacement.
12602 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
Mon P Wangfe6d2cd2009-01-26 04:39:00 +000012603 unsigned LHSInNElts =
12604 cast<VectorType>(LHSSVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012605 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
12606 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Mon P Wangfe6d2cd2009-01-26 04:39:00 +000012607 if (NewMask[i] >= LHSInNElts*2) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012608 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012609 } else {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012610 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012611 }
12612 }
12613 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
12614 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000012615 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012616 }
12617 }
12618 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000012619
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012620 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
12621}
12622
12623
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012624
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012625
12626/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
12627/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
12628/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
12629/// end of its block.
12630static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
12631 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
12632
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000012633 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Duncan Sands7af1c782009-05-06 06:49:50 +000012634 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayHaveSideEffects() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000012635 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012636
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012637 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000012638 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
12639 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012640 return false;
12641
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012642 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
12643 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000012644 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
12645 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012646 Scan != E; ++Scan)
12647 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
12648 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012649 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012650
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000012651 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012652
Dale Johannesenbd8e6502009-03-03 01:09:07 +000012653 CopyPrecedingStopPoint(I, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000012654 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012655 ++NumSunkInst;
12656 return true;
12657}
12658
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012659
12660/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
12661/// all reachable code to the worklist.
12662///
12663/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
12664/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
12665/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
12666/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
12667/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
12668///
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000012669static bool AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012670 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012671 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012672 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000012673 bool MadeIRChange = false;
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000012674 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012675 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattner67f7d542009-10-12 03:58:40 +000012676
12677 std::vector<Instruction*> InstrsForInstCombineWorklist;
12678 InstrsForInstCombineWorklist.reserve(128);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012679
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000012680 SmallPtrSet<ConstantExpr*, 64> FoldedConstants;
12681
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012682 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12683 BB = Worklist.back();
12684 Worklist.pop_back();
12685
12686 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
12687 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012688
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012689 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
12690 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012691
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012692 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
12693 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
12694 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012695 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst << '\n');
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012696 Inst->eraseFromParent();
12697 continue;
12698 }
12699
12700 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000012701 if (!Inst->use_empty() && isa<Constant>(Inst->getOperand(0)))
12702 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, BB->getContext(), TD)) {
12703 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: "
12704 << *Inst << '\n');
12705 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
12706 ++NumConstProp;
12707 Inst->eraseFromParent();
12708 continue;
12709 }
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000012710
12711
12712
12713 if (TD) {
12714 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
12715 for (User::op_iterator i = Inst->op_begin(), e = Inst->op_end();
12716 i != e; ++i) {
12717 ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i);
12718 if (CE == 0) continue;
12719
12720 // If we already folded this constant, don't try again.
12721 if (!FoldedConstants.insert(CE))
12722 continue;
12723
12724 Constant *NewC =
12725 ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, BB->getContext(), TD);
12726 if (NewC && NewC != CE) {
12727 *i = NewC;
12728 MadeIRChange = true;
12729 }
12730 }
12731 }
12732
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012733
Chris Lattner67f7d542009-10-12 03:58:40 +000012734 InstrsForInstCombineWorklist.push_back(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012735 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012736
12737 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
12738 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
12739 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
12740 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
12741 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
12742 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012743 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012744 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012745 continue;
12746 }
12747 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
12748 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
12749 // See if this is an explicit destination.
12750 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12751 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012752 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012753 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012754 continue;
12755 }
12756
12757 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
12758 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
12759 continue;
12760 }
12761 }
12762
12763 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12764 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012765 }
Chris Lattner67f7d542009-10-12 03:58:40 +000012766
12767 // Once we've found all of the instructions to add to instcombine's worklist,
12768 // add them in reverse order. This way instcombine will visit from the top
12769 // of the function down. This jives well with the way that it adds all uses
12770 // of instructions to the worklist after doing a transformation, thus avoiding
12771 // some N^2 behavior in pathological cases.
12772 IC.Worklist.AddInitialGroup(&InstrsForInstCombineWorklist[0],
12773 InstrsForInstCombineWorklist.size());
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000012774
12775 return MadeIRChange;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012776}
12777
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012778bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012779 MadeIRChange = false;
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012780
Daniel Dunbarce63ffb2009-07-25 00:23:56 +000012781 DEBUG(errs() << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
12782 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012783
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012784 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012785 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
12786 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
12787 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012788 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattner2ee743b2009-10-15 04:59:28 +000012789 MadeIRChange |= AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000012790
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012791 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
12792 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
12793 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
12794 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
12795 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
12796 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
12797 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
12798 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000012799
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012800 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *I << '\n');
Dale Johannesenff278b12009-03-10 21:19:49 +000012801 // A debug intrinsic shouldn't force another iteration if we weren't
12802 // going to do one without it.
12803 if (!isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(I)) {
12804 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012805 MadeIRChange = true;
Dale Johannesenff278b12009-03-10 21:19:49 +000012806 }
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000012807
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000012808 // If I is not void type then replaceAllUsesWith undef.
12809 // This allows ValueHandlers and custom metadata to adjust itself.
Devang Patel9674d152009-10-14 17:29:00 +000012810 if (!I->getType()->isVoidTy())
Devang Patel228ebd02009-10-13 22:56:32 +000012811 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012812 I->eraseFromParent();
12813 }
12814 }
12815 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012816
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000012817 while (!Worklist.isEmpty()) {
12818 Instruction *I = Worklist.RemoveOne();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012819 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012820
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012821 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012822 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012823 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *I << '\n');
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012824 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
12825 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012826 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012827 continue;
12828 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012829
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012830 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000012831 if (!I->use_empty() && isa<Constant>(I->getOperand(0)))
12832 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, F.getContext(), TD)) {
12833 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I << '\n');
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012834
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000012835 // Add operands to the worklist.
12836 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
12837 ++NumConstProp;
12838 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
12839 MadeIRChange = true;
12840 continue;
12841 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012842
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012843 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000012844 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012845 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
Chris Lattner8db2cd12009-10-14 15:21:58 +000012846 Instruction *UserInst = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back());
12847 BasicBlock *UserParent;
12848
12849 // Get the block the use occurs in.
12850 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(UserInst))
12851 UserParent = PN->getIncomingBlock(I->use_begin().getUse());
12852 else
12853 UserParent = UserInst->getParent();
12854
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012855 if (UserParent != BB) {
12856 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
12857 // See if the user is one of our successors.
12858 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
12859 if (*SI == UserParent) {
12860 UserIsSuccessor = true;
12861 break;
12862 }
12863
12864 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
12865 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
12866 // otherwise), we can keep going.
Chris Lattner8db2cd12009-10-14 15:21:58 +000012867 if (UserIsSuccessor && UserParent->getSinglePredecessor())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012868 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012869 MadeIRChange |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012870 }
12871 }
12872
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000012873 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it.
12874 Builder->SetInsertPoint(I->getParent(), I);
12875
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012876#ifndef NDEBUG
12877 std::string OrigI;
12878#endif
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012879 DEBUG(raw_string_ostream SS(OrigI); I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Jeffrey Yasskin43069632009-10-08 00:12:24 +000012880 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Visiting: " << OrigI << '\n');
12881
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012882 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000012883 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012884 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012885 if (Result != I) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012886 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Old = " << *I << '\n'
12887 << " New = " << *Result << '\n');
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012888
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012889 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
12890 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
12891
12892 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012893 Worklist.Add(Result);
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +000012894 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012895
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012896 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
12897 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012898
12899 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
12900 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000012901 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
12902
12903 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
12904 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
12905 ++InsertPos;
12906
12907 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012908
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012909 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000012910 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012911#ifndef NDEBUG
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012912 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI << '\n'
12913 << " New = " << *I << '\n');
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012914#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012915
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012916 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
12917 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012918 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012919 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012920 } else {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012921 Worklist.Add(I);
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +000012922 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012923 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012924 }
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012925 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012926 }
12927 }
12928
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000012929 Worklist.Zap();
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012930 return MadeIRChange;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012931}
12932
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012933
12934bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000012935 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
Owen Andersone922c022009-07-22 00:24:57 +000012936 Context = &F.getContext();
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000012937 TD = getAnalysisIfAvailable<TargetData>();
12938
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000012939
12940 /// Builder - This is an IRBuilder that automatically inserts new
12941 /// instructions into the worklist when they are created.
Chris Lattnere2cc1ad2009-10-15 04:13:44 +000012942 IRBuilder<true, TargetFolder, InstCombineIRInserter>
12943 TheBuilder(F.getContext(), TargetFolder(TD, F.getContext()),
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000012944 InstCombineIRInserter(Worklist));
12945 Builder = &TheBuilder;
12946
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012947 bool EverMadeChange = false;
12948
12949 // Iterate while there is work to do.
12950 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000012951 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012952 EverMadeChange = true;
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000012953
12954 Builder = 0;
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012955 return EverMadeChange;
12956}
12957
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000012958FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012959 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012960}